blob: aedad72037ea545798a8033e00f7f86af6909d0e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
84
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000223 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
224 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000225 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
226 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000227 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000228 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000229 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000230 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000231 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000232 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000233 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000234 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000235 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000236 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000237
238 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000239 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000240
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000241 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000242 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000243 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000244 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000245 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
246 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000247 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000248
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000249 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000250 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
251 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
252 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000253 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000254 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
255 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000256 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
257 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000258 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000259 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000260 }
261
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000262 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
263 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
264 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000265 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
266 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000267 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000268
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000269 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000270 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000271
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000272 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000273 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000274 return C;
275 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000276
277 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
278 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
279 }
280
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000281
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000282 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
283 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
284 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
285 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
286 // modified.
287 //
288 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000289 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000290 if (&I != V) {
291 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
292 return &I;
293 } else {
294 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
295 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000296 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000297 return &I;
298 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000299 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000300
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000301 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
302 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
303 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
304 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
305 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
306 //
307 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
308 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
309 if (Old != New)
310 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
311 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000312 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000313 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000314 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000315 return true;
316 }
317
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000318 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
319 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
320 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
321 // this function.
322 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
323 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
324 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000325 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000326 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000327 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
328 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000329
330 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
331 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
332 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
333 }
334
335 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
336 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
337 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
338 }
339 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
340 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
341 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000342
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000343 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000344 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
345 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
346 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
347 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000348 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
349 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000350 Instruction *InsertBefore);
351
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000352 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
353 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000354 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000355
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000356 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
357 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
358 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
359
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000360 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
361 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000362 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
363 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
364 unsigned Depth = 0);
365
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000366 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
367 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
368
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000369 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
370 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
371 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
372 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
373
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000374 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
375 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
376 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
379
380
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000381 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
382 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000383
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000384 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000385 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000386 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000387 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000388 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000389 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000390 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000391 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000393
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000394
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000395 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000396
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
398 unsigned CastOpc,
399 int &NumCastsRemoved);
400 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
401 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000402
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000403 };
404}
405
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000406char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
407static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
408X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
409
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000410// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000411// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000412static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
413 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
414 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000415 return 3;
416 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000417 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000418 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
419 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000420}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000421
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000422// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
423// it.
424static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000425 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000426}
427
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000428// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
429// though a va_arg area...
430static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000431 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
432 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
433 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000434 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000435 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000436}
437
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000438/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
439/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
440static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
441 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000442 return I->getOperand(0);
443 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000444 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return CE->getOperand(0);
446 return 0;
447}
448
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000449/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
450/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451static Instruction::CastOps
452isEliminableCastPair(
453 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
454 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
455 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
456 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
457) {
458
459 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
460 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000461
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000462 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
463 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
464 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000465
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000466 return Instruction::CastOps(
467 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
468 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000469}
470
471/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
472/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
473/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000474static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
475 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000476 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
477
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000478 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000479 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000480 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000481 return false;
482 return true;
483}
484
485/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
486/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
487/// casts that are known to not do anything...
488///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000489Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
490 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000491 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
492 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
493 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000494 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000495
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000496 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497}
498
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000499// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
500// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000501//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000502// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
503// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
504// binary operators.
505//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000506// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
507// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000508//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000509bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000510 bool Changed = false;
511 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
512 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000513
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000514 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
515 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000516 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
517 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
518 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000519 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
520 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
521 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000522 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
523 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
524 return true;
525 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
526 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
527 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
528 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
529 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
530
531 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000532 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000533 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000534 Op1->getOperand(0),
535 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000536 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 I.setOperand(0, New);
538 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
539 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000540 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000541 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000542 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000543}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000544
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000545/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
546/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
547/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
548bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
549 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
550 return false;
551 I.swapOperands();
552 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
553 return true;
554}
555
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000556// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
557// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000558//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000559static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
560 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000561 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000562
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000563 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
564 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
565 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000566
567 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
568 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
569 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
570
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000571 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000572}
573
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000574static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
575 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000576 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577
578 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000579 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000580 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000581 return 0;
582}
583
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000584// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
585// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000586// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
587// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000588//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000589static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000590 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000591 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000592 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000593 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000594 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000595 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000596 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000597 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000598 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000599 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000600 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000601 return I->getOperand(0);
602 }
603 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000604 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000605}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000606
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000607/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
608/// expression, return it.
609static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
610 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
611 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
612 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
613 return cast<User>(V);
614 return false;
615}
616
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000617/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
618/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000619static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
620 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000621 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000622 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000623 return CE->getOpcode();
624 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
625 return Instruction::UserOp1;
626}
627
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000628/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000629static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000630 APInt Val(C->getValue());
631 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000632}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000633/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000634static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000635 APInt Val(C->getValue());
636 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000637}
638/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
639static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
640 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
641}
642/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
643static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
644 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
645}
646/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
647static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
648 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
649}
650/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
651static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
652 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000654/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
655/// this size.
656static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
657 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
658 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
659 if (sign) {
660 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
661 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
662 } else {
663 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
664 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
665 }
666
667 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
668
669 if (sign) {
670 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
671 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
672 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
673 } else
674 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
675}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000676
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000677
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000678/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
679/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
680/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
681/// constant and return true.
682static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000683 APInt Demanded) {
684 assert(I && "No instruction?");
685 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
686
687 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
688 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
689 if (!OpC) return false;
690
691 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
692 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
693 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
694 return false;
695
696 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
697 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
698 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
699 return true;
700}
701
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000702// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
703// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
704// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
705// min/max.
706static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000707 const APInt& KnownZero,
708 const APInt& KnownOne,
709 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
710 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
711 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
712 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
713 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
714 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000715 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000716
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000717 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
718 // bit if it is unknown.
719 Min = KnownOne;
720 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
721
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000722 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000723 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
724 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000725 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000726}
727
728// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
729// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
730// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
731// min/max.
732static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000733 const APInt &KnownZero,
734 const APInt &KnownOne,
735 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
736 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000737 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
738 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
739 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
740 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000741 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000742
743 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
744 Min = KnownOne;
745 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
746 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
747}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000748
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000749/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
750/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
751/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
752/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
753/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
754/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
755/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
756/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
757/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
758/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
759/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
760/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
761/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
762/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
763/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
764bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
765 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
766 unsigned Depth) {
767 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
768 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
769 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
770 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
771 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
772 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
773 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
774 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
775 must have same BitWidth");
776 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
777 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
778 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
779 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
780 return false;
781 }
782
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000783 KnownZero.clear();
784 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000785 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
786 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
787 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
788 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
789 return false;
790 }
791 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
792 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
793 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
794 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
795 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
796 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
797 return false;
798 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
799 return false;
800 }
801
802 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
803 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
804
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000805 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
806 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
807 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000808 default:
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
810 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000811 case Instruction::And:
812 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
813 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
814 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
815 return true;
816 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
817 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
818
819 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
820 // LHS.
821 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
822 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
823 return true;
824 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
825 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
826
827 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
828 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
829 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
830 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
831 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
832 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
833 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
834 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
835
836 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
837 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
838 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
839
840 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
841 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
842 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
843
844 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
845 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
846 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
847 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
848 break;
849 case Instruction::Or:
850 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
851 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
852 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
853 return true;
854 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
855 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
856 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
857 // LHS.
858 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
859 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
860 return true;
861 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
862 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
863
864 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
865 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
866 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
867 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
868 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
869 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
870 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
871 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
872
873 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
874 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
875 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
876 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
877 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
878 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
879 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
880 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
881
882 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
883 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
884 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
885
886 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
887 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
888 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
889 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
890 break;
891 case Instruction::Xor: {
892 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
893 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
894 return true;
895 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
896 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
897 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
898 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
899 return true;
900 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
901 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
902
903 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
904 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
905 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
906 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
907 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
908 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
909
910 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
911 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
912 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
913 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
914 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
915 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
916
917 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
918 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
919 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
920 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
921 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000922 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000923 I->getName());
924 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
925 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
926 }
927
928 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
929 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
930 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
931 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
932 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
933 // all known
934 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
935 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
936 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000937 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000938 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
939 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
940 }
941 }
942
943 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
944 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
945 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
947
948 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
949 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
950 break;
951 }
952 case Instruction::Select:
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
954 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
957 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
958 return true;
959 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
960 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
961 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
962 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
963
964 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
965 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
966 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
967 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
968 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
969
970 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
971 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
972 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
973 break;
974 case Instruction::Trunc: {
975 uint32_t truncBf =
976 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000977 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
978 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
979 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
980 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
981 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000982 return true;
983 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
984 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
985 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
986 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
987 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
988 break;
989 }
990 case Instruction::BitCast:
991 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
992 return false;
993
994 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
995 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
996 return true;
997 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
998 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
999 break;
1000 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1001 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1002 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001003 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001004
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001005 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1007 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001008 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1009 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001010 return true;
1011 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1012 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1013 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1014 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1015 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1016 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001017 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001018 break;
1019 }
1020 case Instruction::SExt: {
1021 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1022 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001023 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001024
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001026 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001027
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001028 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001029 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1030 // bit is demanded.
1031 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001032 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001033
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001034 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1036 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001037 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1038 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 return true;
1040 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1041 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1042 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1043 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1044 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1045
1046 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1047 // top bits of the result.
1048
1049 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1050 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001051 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001052 {
1053 // Convert to ZExt cast
1054 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1055 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001056 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001058 }
1059 break;
1060 }
1061 case Instruction::Add: {
1062 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1063 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1064 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001065 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001066
1067 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1068 // we can do.
1069 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1070 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1071 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1072 if (RHS->isZero())
1073 break;
1074
1075 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1076 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078
1079 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1080 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1081 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1082 return true;
1083
1084 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1085 // the constant.
1086 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1087 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1088
1089 // Avoid excess work.
1090 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1091 break;
1092
1093 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1094 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1095 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001096 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001097 I->getName());
1098 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1099 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1100 }
1101
1102 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1103 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1104 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1105 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1106 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1107
1108 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1109 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1110 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001111 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1112 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001113
1114 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1115
1116 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1117 // other, and there is no input carry.
1118 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1119 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1120
1121 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1122 // is no input carry.
1123 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1124 } else {
1125 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1126 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001127 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001128 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1129 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001130 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001131 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1132 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1133 return true;
1134 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1135 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1136 return true;
1137 }
1138 }
1139 break;
1140 }
1141 case Instruction::Sub:
1142 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1143 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001144 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001145 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1146 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001147 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1150 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1151 return true;
1152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001156 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1157 // the known zeros and ones.
1158 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001159 break;
1160 case Instruction::Shl:
1161 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001162 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001163 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1164 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1166 return true;
1167 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1168 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1169 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1170 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1171 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001172 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001173 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001174 }
1175 break;
1176 case Instruction::LShr:
1177 // For a logical shift right
1178 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001179 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001182 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1183 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001184 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1185 return true;
1186 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1187 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001188 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1189 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001190 if (ShiftAmt) {
1191 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001192 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1194 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::AShr:
1198 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1199 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1200 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1201 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1202 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1203 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001204 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1206 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1207 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1208 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001209
1210 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1211 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1212 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1213 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001214
1215 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001216 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001219 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001220 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1221 // demanded.
1222 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1223 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001224 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001225 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1227 return true;
1228 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1229 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1230 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001231 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001232 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1233 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1234
1235 // Handle the sign bits.
1236 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1237 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1238 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1239
1240 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1241 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001242 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001243 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1244 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001245 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001246 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1247 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1248 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1249 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1250 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1251 }
1252 }
1253 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001254 case Instruction::SRem:
1255 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1256 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1257 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001258 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1259 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1260
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001261 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001262 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1263 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1264 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1265 return true;
1266
1267 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1268 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001269
1270 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001271
1272 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1273 }
1274 }
1275 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001276 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001277 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1278 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001279 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1280 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1281 return true;
1282
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001283 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001285 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1289 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1290 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001291 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001292 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001293 case Instruction::Call:
1294 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1295 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1296 default: break;
1297 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1298 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1299 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1300 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1301 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1302
1303 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1304 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1305 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1306 NLZ &= ~7;
1307 NTZ &= ~7;
1308 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1309 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1310 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1311 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1312
1313 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1314 // the right place.
1315 Instruction *NewVal;
1316 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1317 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1318 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1319 else
1320 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1321 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1322 NewVal->takeName(I);
1323 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1324 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1325 }
1326
1327 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1328 break;
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001332 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001333 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001334 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001335
1336 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1337 // constant.
1338 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1339 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1340 return false;
1341}
1342
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001343
1344/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1345/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1346/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1347/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1348///
1349/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1350/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1351/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1352Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1353 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1354 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001355 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001356 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1357 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1358 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1359 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1360
1361 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1362 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1363 UndefElts = EltMask;
1364 return 0;
1365 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1366 UndefElts = EltMask;
1367 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1368 }
1369
1370 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001371 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1372 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001373 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1374
1375 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1376 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1377 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1378 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1379 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1380 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1381 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1382 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1383 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1384 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1385 }
1386
1387 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001388 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001389 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1390 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001392 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001393 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001394 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1395 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1396 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1397 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1398 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1399 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001400 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001401 }
1402
1403 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1404 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1405 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1406 return false;
1407 }
1408 return false;
1409 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1410 return false;
1411 }
1412
1413 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1414 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1415
1416 bool MadeChange = false;
1417 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1418 Value *TmpV;
1419 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1420 default: break;
1421
1422 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1423 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1424 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001425 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001426 if (Idx == 0) {
1427 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1428 // which elt is getting updated.
1429 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1430 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1431 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1432 break;
1433 }
1434
1435 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1436 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001437 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001438 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1439 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1440
1441 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1442 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1443 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1444 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1445 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1446 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1447
1448 // The inserted element is defined.
1449 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1450 break;
1451 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001452 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001453 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001454 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1455 if (!VTy) break;
1456 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1457 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1458 unsigned Ratio;
1459
1460 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001461 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001462 // elements as are demanded of us.
1463 Ratio = 1;
1464 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1465 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1466 // Untested so far.
1467 break;
1468
1469 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1470 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1471 // elements are live.
1472 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1473 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1474 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1475 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1476 }
1477 } else {
1478 // Untested so far.
1479 break;
1480
1481 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1482 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1483 // live.
1484 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1485 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1486 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1487 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1488 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001489
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001490 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1491 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1492 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1493 if (TmpV) {
1494 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1495 MadeChange = true;
1496 }
1497
1498 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1499 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1500 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1501 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1502 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1503 // undef.
1504 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1505 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1506 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1507 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1508 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1509 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1510 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1511 // elements are undef.
1512 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1513 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1514 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1515 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1516 }
1517 break;
1518 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001519 case Instruction::And:
1520 case Instruction::Or:
1521 case Instruction::Xor:
1522 case Instruction::Add:
1523 case Instruction::Sub:
1524 case Instruction::Mul:
1525 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1526 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1527 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1528 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1529 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1530 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1531 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1532
1533 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1534 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1535 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1536 break;
1537
1538 case Instruction::Call: {
1539 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1540 if (!II) break;
1541 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1542 default: break;
1543
1544 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1545 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1546 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1547 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1548 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1549 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1550 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1551 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1552 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1553 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1554 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1555 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1556 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1557 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1558 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1559 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1560
1561 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1562 // scalarize it now.
1563 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1564 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1565 default: break;
1566 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1567 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1568 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1569 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1570 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1571 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1572 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1573 // Extract the element as scalars.
1574 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1575 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1576
1577 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1578 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1579 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1580 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001581 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001582 II->getName()), *II);
1583 break;
1584 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1585 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001586 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001587 II->getName()), *II);
1588 break;
1589 }
1590
1591 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001592 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1593 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001594 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1595 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1596 return New;
1597 }
1598 }
1599
1600 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1601 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1602 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1603 break;
1604 }
1605 break;
1606 }
1607 }
1608 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1609}
1610
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001611
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001612/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1613/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1614/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1615/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1616/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1617/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1618/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1619///
1620template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001621static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001622 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1623 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1624
1625 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1626 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1627 return F.apply(Root);
1628
1629 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1630 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001631 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001632 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1633 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1634
1635 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1636 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1637 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1638 ShouldApply = true;
1639 }
1640
1641 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1642 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1643 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001644 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1645 // and perform the reassociation.
1646 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1647
1648 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1649 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1650
1651 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1652 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001653 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001654 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1655 return 0;
1656 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001657 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001658 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001659 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001660 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001661 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001662
1663 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1664 // get to LHSI.
1665 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1666 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001667 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1668 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001669 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001670 ARI = NextLHSI;
1671
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001672 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1673 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1674 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1675 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1676 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001677
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001678 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1679 // the transformation...
1680 return F.apply(Root);
1681 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001682
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001683 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1684 }
1685 return 0;
1686}
1687
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001688namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001689
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001690// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001691struct AddRHS {
1692 Value *RHS;
1693 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1694 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1695 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001696 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1697 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001698 }
1699};
1700
1701// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1702// iff C1&C2 == 0
1703struct AddMaskingAnd {
1704 Constant *C2;
1705 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1706 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001707 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001708 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001709 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001710 }
1711 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001712 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001713 }
1714};
1715
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001716}
1717
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001718static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001719 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001720 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001721 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001722 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001723
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001724 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001725 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001726 }
1727
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001728 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001729 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1730 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001731
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001732 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1733 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001734 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1735 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001736 }
1737
1738 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1739 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1740 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1741 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001742 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001743 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001744 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001745 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001746 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001747 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001748 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001749 abort();
1750 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001751 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1752}
1753
1754// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1755// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1756// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1757// not have a second operand.
1758static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1759 InstCombiner *IC) {
1760 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1761 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1762 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1763 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1764
1765 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001766 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001767 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001768
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001769 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1770 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1771
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001772 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1773 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001774 }
1775 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001776}
1777
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001778
1779/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1780/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1781/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1782Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1783 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001784 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001785 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001786
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001787 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1788 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001789 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001790 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1791 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1792 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1793 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001794 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001795 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1796
1797 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1798 // loop.
1799 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1800 return 0;
1801 }
1802
1803 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1804 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1805 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1806 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1807 if (NonConstBB) {
1808 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1809 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1810 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001811
1812 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001813 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001814 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001815 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001816 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001817
1818 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1819 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1820 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001821 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001822 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001823 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001824 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1825 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1826 else
1827 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001828 } else {
1829 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1830 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001831 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001832 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1833 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001834 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001835 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001836 CI->getPredicate(),
1837 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1838 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001839 else
1840 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1841
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001842 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001843 }
1844 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001845 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001846 } else {
1847 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1848 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001849 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001850 Value *InV;
1851 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001852 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001853 } else {
1854 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001855 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001856 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1857 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001858 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001859 }
1860 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001861 }
1862 }
1863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1864}
1865
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001866
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001867/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1868/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1869/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1870/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1871bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1872 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1873 // ones.
1874
1875 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1876 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1877 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1878 // sign extend fine.
1879 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1880 return true;
1881
1882
1883 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1884 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1885 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1886 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1887
1888 // TODO: Implement.
1889
1890 return false;
1891}
1892
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001893
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001894Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001895 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001896 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001897
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001898 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001899 // X + undef -> undef
1900 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1902
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001903 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001904 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001905 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001907 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001908 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1909 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001911 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001912
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001913 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001914 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001915 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001916 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001917 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001918 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001919
1920 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1921 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001922 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1923 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1924 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1925 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1926 return &I;
1927 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001928 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001929
1930 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1931 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1932 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001933
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001934 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1935 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001936 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1937 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001938 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001939 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001940
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001941 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001942 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1943 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001944 do {
1945 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001946 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1947 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001948 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1949 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001950 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001951 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1952 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001953 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001954 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001955 }
1956 }
1957 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001958 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1959 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1960 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001961
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001962 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00001963 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
1964 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
1965 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001966 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1967 switch (Size) {
1968 default: break;
1969 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1970 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1971 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1972 }
1973 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001974 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001975 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001976 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001977 }
1978 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001979 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001980
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001981 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
1982 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
1983
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00001984 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00001985 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001986 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00001987
1988 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
1989 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1990 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
1991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
1992 }
1993 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
1994 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1995 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
1996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
1997 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00001998 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00001999
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002000 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002001 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2002 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002003 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2004 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002005 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002006 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002007 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002008 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002009 }
2010
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002011 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002012 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002013
2014 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002015 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2016 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002017 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002018
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002019
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002020 ConstantInt *C2;
2021 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2022 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002023 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002024
2025 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2026 ConstantInt *C1;
2027 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002028 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002029 }
2030
2031 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002032 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002033 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002034
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002035 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002036 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002038
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002039
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002040 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002041 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002042 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2043 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002044
2045 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2046 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2047 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2048 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2049 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2050 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2051 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2052 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2053 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2054 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2055
2056 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002057 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002058 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002059 }
2060 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002061
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002062 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002063 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002064 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2065 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2066 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2067 if (W != Y) {
2068 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002069 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002070 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002071 std::swap(W, X);
2072 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002073 std::swap(Y, Z);
2074 std::swap(W, X);
2075 }
2076 }
2077
2078 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002079 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002080 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002081 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002082 }
2083 }
2084 }
2085
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002086 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002087 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002088 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002089 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002090
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002091 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2092 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002093 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002094 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2095 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2096 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002097 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002098
2099 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002100 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002101
2102 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002103 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002104
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002105 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2106 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002107 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002108 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002109 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002110 }
2111 }
2112 }
2113
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002114 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2115 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002116 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002117 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002118 }
2119
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002120 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002121 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002122 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002123 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2124 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002125 if (!CI) {
2126 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2127 Other = LHS;
2128 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002129 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002130 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2131 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002132 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002133 unsigned AS =
2134 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002135 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2136 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002137 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002138 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002139 }
2140 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002141
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002142 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002143 {
2144 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2145 Value *Other = RHS;
2146 if (!SI) {
2147 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2148 Other = LHS;
2149 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002150 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002151 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2152 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002153 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002154
2155 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2156 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002157 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2158 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002159 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002160 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2161 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002162 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002163 }
2164 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002165
2166 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2167 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2168 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2169 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002170
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002171 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2172 // integer add followed by a sext.
2173 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2174 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2175 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2176 Constant *CI =
2177 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2178 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2179 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2180 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2181 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2182 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2183 CI, "addconv");
2184 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2185 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2186 }
2187 }
2188
2189 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2190 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2191 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2192 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2193 // integer add will not overflow.
2194 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2195 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2196 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2197 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2198 // Insert the new integer add.
2199 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2200 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2201 "addconv");
2202 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2203 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2204 }
2205 }
2206 }
2207
2208 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2209 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2210 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2211 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2212 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2213 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2214 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2215 // instcombined.
2216 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2217 Constant *CI =
2218 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2219 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2220 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2221 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2222 // Insert the new integer add.
2223 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2224 CI, "addconv");
2225 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2226 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2227 }
2228 }
2229
2230 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2231 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2232 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2233 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2234 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2235 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2236 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2237 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2238 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2239 // Insert the new integer add.
2240 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2241 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2242 "addconv");
2243 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2244 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2245 }
2246 }
2247 }
2248
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002249 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002250}
2251
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002252Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002253 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002254
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002255 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2256 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002258
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002259 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002260 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002261 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002262
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002263 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2265 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2266 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2267
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002268 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2269 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002270 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002271 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002272
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002273 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002274 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002275 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002276 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002277
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002278 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2279 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002280 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002281 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002282 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002283 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002284 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002285 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002286 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002287 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002288 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002289 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002290 }
2291 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002292 }
2293 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2294 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2295 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002296 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002297 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002298 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002299 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002300 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002301 }
2302 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002303 }
2304 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002305 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002306
2307 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2308 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002309 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002310 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002311
2312 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2313 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2314 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002315 }
2316
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002317 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2318 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2319
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002320 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2321 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002322 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002323 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002324 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002325 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002326 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002327 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2328 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2329 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002330 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002331 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2332 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002333 }
2334
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002335 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002336 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2337 // is not used by anyone else...
2338 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002339 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002340 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002341 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2342 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2343 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2344 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002345
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002346 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002347 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002348 }
2349
2350 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2351 //
2352 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2353 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2354 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2355
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002356 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002357 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2358 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002359 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002360
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002361 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002362 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002363 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002364 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002365 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002366 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002367 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2368
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002369 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002370 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002371 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002372 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002373 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002374 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002375
2376 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2377 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2378 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2379 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2380 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2381 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002382 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002383 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002384 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002385 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002386 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002387 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002388
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002389 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002390 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002391 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002392 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2394 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002396 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2397 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002398 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002399 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002400 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002401
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002402 ConstantInt *C1;
2403 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002404 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002405 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002406
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002407 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2408 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002409 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002410 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002411 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002412}
2413
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002414/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2415/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2416/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2417/// signed.
2418static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2419 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002420 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002421 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2422 TrueIfSigned = true;
2423 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002424 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2425 TrueIfSigned = true;
2426 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002427 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2428 TrueIfSigned = false;
2429 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002430 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2431 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2432 TrueIfSigned = true;
2433 return RHS->getValue() ==
2434 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2435 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2436 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2437 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002438 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002439 default:
2440 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002441 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002442}
2443
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002444Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002445 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002446 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002447
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002448 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2449 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2450
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002451 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002452 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2453 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002454
2455 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002456 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002457 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2458 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002459 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002460 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002461
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002462 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2464 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2465 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2466 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002467 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002468
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002469 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002470 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002471 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002472 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002473 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002474 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002475 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2476 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002477
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002478 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2479 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002480 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2481 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2482 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2483 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2485
2486 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2487 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2488 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2489 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2490 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002491 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002492
2493 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2494 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002495 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002496 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002497 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002498 Op1, "tmp");
2499 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2500 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2501 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002502 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002503
2504 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002505
2506 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2507 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002508 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002509 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002510
2511 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2512 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2513 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002514 }
2515
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002516 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2517 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002518 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002519
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002520 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2521 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2522
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002523 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2524 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2525 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2526 // formed.
2527 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002528 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002529 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002530 BoolCast = CI;
2531 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002532 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002533 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002534 BoolCast = CI;
2535 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002536 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002537 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2538 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002539 bool TIS = false;
2540
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002541 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002542 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2543 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002544 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2545 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002546 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002547 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002548 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002549 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002550 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002551 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002552 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2553 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002554
2555 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2556 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002557 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002558 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2559 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002560 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2561 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2562 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2563 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2564 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002565
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002566 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002567 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002568 }
2569 }
2570 }
2571
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002572 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002573}
2574
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002575/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2576/// instruction.
2577bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2578 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2579
2580 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2581 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2582 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2583 if (ST->isNullValue())
2584 NonNullOperand = 2;
2585 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2586 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2587 if (ST->isNullValue())
2588 NonNullOperand = 1;
2589
2590 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2591 return false;
2592
2593 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2594
2595 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2596 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2597
2598 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2599 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2600 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2601 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2602 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2603
2604 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2605 // early exit.
2606 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2607 return true;
2608
2609 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2610 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2611
2612 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2613 --BBI;
2614 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2615 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2616 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2617 break;
2618
2619 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2620 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2621 I != E; ++I) {
2622 if (*I == SI) {
2623 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2624 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2625 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2626 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2627 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2628 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2629 }
2630 }
2631
2632 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2633 if (&*BBI == SI)
2634 SI = 0;
2635 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2636 SelectCond = 0;
2637
2638 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2639 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2640 break;
2641
2642 }
2643 return true;
2644}
2645
2646
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002647/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2648/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2649/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2650/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002651Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002652 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002653
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002654 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2655 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2656 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2657 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002660 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002661
2662 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002663 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002665
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002666 return 0;
2667}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002668
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002669/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2670/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2671/// division instructions.
2672/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002673Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002674 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2675
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002676 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002677 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2678 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2679 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2680 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2682 }
2683
2684 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2685 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2686 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002687
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002688 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2689 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002690
2691 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2692 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2693 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2694 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002695
2696 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2697 // div X, 1 == X
2698 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2700
2701 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2702 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2703 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2704 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002705 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2706 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2707 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002708 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002709 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002710 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002711
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002712 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002713 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2714 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2715 return R;
2716 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2717 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2718 return NV;
2719 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002720 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002721
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002722 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002723 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002724 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2726
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002727 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2728 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2729 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2730
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002731 return 0;
2732}
2733
2734Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2735 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2736
2737 // Handle the integer div common cases
2738 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2739 return Common;
2740
2741 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2742 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2743 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2744 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002745 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002746 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002747 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002748 }
2749
2750 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002751 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002752 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2753 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002754 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002755 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002756 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002757 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002758 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002759 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002760 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002761 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002762 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002763 }
2764 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002765 }
2766
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002767 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2768 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002769 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002770 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002771 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002772 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002773 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002774 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002775 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002776 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2777 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002778 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002779 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2780 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2781
2782 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2783 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002784 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002785 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2786 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002787
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002788 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002789 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002790 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002791 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002792 return 0;
2793}
2794
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002795Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2796 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2797
2798 // Handle the integer div common cases
2799 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2800 return Common;
2801
2802 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2803 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2804 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002805 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002806
2807 // -X/C -> X/-C
2808 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002809 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002810 }
2811
2812 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2813 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002814 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002815 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002816 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002817 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002818 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002819 }
2820 }
2821
2822 return 0;
2823}
2824
2825Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2826 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2827}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002828
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002829/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2830/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2831/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2832/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2833Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002834 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002835
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002836 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002837 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2838 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2840
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002841 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2842 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2843 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002845 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002846 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002848
2849 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002850 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2851 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002852
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002853 return 0;
2854}
2855
2856/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2857/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2858/// remainder instructions.
2859/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2860Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2861 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2862
2863 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2864 return common;
2865
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002866 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002867 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2868 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2870
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002871 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2872 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2873
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002874 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2875 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2876 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2877 return R;
2878 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2879 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2880 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002881 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002882
2883 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2884 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2885 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2886 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2887 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2888 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002889 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002890 }
2891
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002892 return 0;
2893}
2894
2895Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2896 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2897
2898 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2899 return common;
2900
2901 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2902 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2903 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2904 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2905 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002906 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002907 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002908 }
2909
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002910 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002911 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2912 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2913 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002914 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002915 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002916 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002917 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002918 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002919 }
2920 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002921 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002922
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002923 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2924 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2925 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2926 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2927 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2928 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002929 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2930 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002931 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002932 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002933 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002934 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002935 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002936 }
2937 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002938 }
2939
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002940 return 0;
2941}
2942
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002943Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2944 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2945
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002946 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002947 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2948 return common;
2949
2950 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00002951 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
2952 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
2953 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002954 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2955 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2956 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2957 return &I;
2958 }
2959
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002960 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002961 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002962 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
2963 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
2964 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2965 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002966 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002967 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002968 }
2969
2970 return 0;
2971}
2972
2973Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002974 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2975}
2976
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002977// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2978// constant.
2979static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002980 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002981}
2982
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002983// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2984// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2985static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002986 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002987}
2988
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002989/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002990/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2991///
2992/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2993///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002994/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2995/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002996///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002997/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2998/// 0 A > B
2999/// 1 A == B
3000/// 2 A < B
3001///
3002/// <=> Value Definition
3003/// 000 0 Always false
3004/// 001 1 A > B
3005/// 010 2 A == B
3006/// 011 3 A >= B
3007/// 100 4 A < B
3008/// 101 5 A != B
3009/// 110 6 A <= B
3010/// 111 7 Always true
3011///
3012static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3013 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003014 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003015 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3017 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3018 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3019 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3020 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3021 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3022 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3023 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003025 // True -> 7
3026 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003027 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003028 return 0;
3029 }
3030}
3031
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003032/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3033/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003034/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003035/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
3036static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3037 switch (code) {
3038 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003039 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003040 case 1:
3041 if (sign)
3042 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3043 else
3044 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3045 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3046 case 3:
3047 if (sign)
3048 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3049 else
3050 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3051 case 4:
3052 if (sign)
3053 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3054 else
3055 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3056 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3057 case 6:
3058 if (sign)
3059 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3060 else
3061 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003062 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003063 }
3064}
3065
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003066static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3067 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3068 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3069 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3070 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3071 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3072}
3073
3074namespace {
3075// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3076struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003077 InstCombiner &IC;
3078 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003079 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3080 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3081 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3082 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003083 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003084 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3085 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003086 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3087 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003088 return false;
3089 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003090 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3091 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3092 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3093 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3094 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003095 }
3096
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003097 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003098 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003099 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003100 unsigned Code;
3101 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3102 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3103 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3104 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003105 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003106 }
3107
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003108 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3109 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3110
3111 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003112 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3113 return I;
3114 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3115 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3116 }
3117};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003118} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003119
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003120// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3121// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003122// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003123Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003124 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3125 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003126 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3127 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003128 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003129 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003130 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003131
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003132 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3133 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003134 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003135 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003136 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003137 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003138 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003139 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003140 }
3141 break;
3142 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003143 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003145
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003146 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3147 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003148 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003149 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003150 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003151 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003152 }
3153 break;
3154 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003155 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003156 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3157 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3158 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003159 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003160
3161 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003162 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003163 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3164 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3165 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003166 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003167
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003168 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3169 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3170 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3171 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3172 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3173 // no effect.
3174 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3175 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3176 return &TheAnd;
3177 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003178 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003179 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003180 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003181 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003182 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003183 }
3184 }
3185 }
3186 }
3187 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003188
3189 case Instruction::Shl: {
3190 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3191 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3192 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003193 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003194 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003195 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3196 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003197
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003198 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3199 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3201 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003202 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3203 return &TheAnd;
3204 }
3205 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003206 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003207 case Instruction::LShr:
3208 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003209 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3210 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3211 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3212 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003213 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003214 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003215 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3216 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003217
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003218 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3219 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3221 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3222 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3223 return &TheAnd;
3224 }
3225 break;
3226 }
3227 case Instruction::AShr:
3228 // Signed shr.
3229 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3230 // with an and.
3231 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003232 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003233 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003234 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3235 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003236 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003237 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003238 // Make the argument unsigned.
3239 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003240 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003241 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003242 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003243 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003244 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003245 }
3246 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003247 }
3248 return 0;
3249}
3250
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003251
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003252/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3253/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003254/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3255/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003256/// insert new instructions.
3257Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003258 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3259 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003260 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003261 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003262 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003263
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003264 if (Inside) {
3265 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003266 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003267
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003268 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003269 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003270 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003271 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3272 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3273 }
3274
3275 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3276 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003277 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003278 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003279 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3280 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003281 }
3282
3283 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003284 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003285
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003286 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003287 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003288 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003289 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3290 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3291 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3292 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003293
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003294 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3295 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3296 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003297 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003298 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003299 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3300 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003301}
3302
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003303// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3304// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3305// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3306// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003307static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003308 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003309 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3310 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003311
3312 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003313 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003314 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003315 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003316 return true;
3317}
3318
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003319/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3320/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3321/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003322///
3323/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3324/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3325/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3326///
3327/// return (A +/- B).
3328///
3329Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003330 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003331 Instruction &I) {
3332 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3333 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3334 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3335
3336 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3337
3338 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3339 default: return 0;
3340 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003341 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003342 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003343 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3344 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3345 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003346 break;
3347
3348 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3349 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3350 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003351 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003352 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003353 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003354 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003355 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003356 break;
3357 }
3358 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003359 return 0;
3360 case Instruction::Or:
3361 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003362 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003363 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3364 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003365 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003366 break;
3367 return 0;
3368 }
3369
3370 Instruction *New;
3371 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003372 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003373 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003374 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003375 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3376}
3377
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003378Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003379 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003380 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003381
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003382 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3384
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003385 // and X, X = X
3386 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003387 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003388
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003389 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003390 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003391 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003392 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3393 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3394 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003395 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003396 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003397 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003398 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003399 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003400 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003401 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003403 }
3404 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003405
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003406 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003407 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3408 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003409
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003410 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003411 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003412 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003413 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3414 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3415 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3416 case Instruction::Xor:
3417 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003418 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3419 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3420 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3421 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003422 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003423 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3424 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003425 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003426 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003427 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003428 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003429 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3430 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003431 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003432 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3433 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003434 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003435 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3436 }
3437 }
3438
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003439 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003440 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003441 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3442 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3443 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3444 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003445 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003446 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003447 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003448 break;
3449
3450 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003451 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3452 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3453 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3454 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003455 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003456
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003457 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3458 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3459 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3460 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3461 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3462 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3463
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003464 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003465 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3466 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003467 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3468 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3469 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3470 }
3471 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003472 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003473
3474 case Instruction::Shl:
3475 case Instruction::LShr:
3476 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3477 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003478 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003479 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3480 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3481 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3482 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3483 }
3484 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003485 }
3486
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003487 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003488 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003489 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003490 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003491 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3492 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3493 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3494 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003495 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003496 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003497 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003498 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3499 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003500 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3501 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3502 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003503 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003504 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3505 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003506 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003507 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003508 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003509 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003510 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003511 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3512 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3513 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003514 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003515 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3517 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003518 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003519 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003520 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003521
3522 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3523 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003524 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003525 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003526 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3527 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3528 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003529 }
3530
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003531 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3532 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003533
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003534 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3535 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3536
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003537 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003538 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003539 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003540 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003541 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003542 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003543 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003544
3545 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003546 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3547 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003548 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3549 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003550
3551 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3552 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3553 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003554 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003555 }
3556 }
3557
3558 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003559 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003561
3562 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3563 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3564 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003565 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003566 }
3567 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003568
3569 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3570 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3571 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3572 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3573 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3574 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3575 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3576 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3577 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3578 }
3579 }
3580 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3581 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3582 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3583 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3584 std::swap(A, B);
3585 }
3586 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003587 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003588 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003589 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003590 }
3591 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003592 }
3593
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003594 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3595 // where C is a power of 2
3596 Value *A, *B;
3597 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003598 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3599 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003600 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3601 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3602 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3603 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3604 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3605 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3606 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3607 }
3608 }
3609
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003610 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3611 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3612 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003613 return R;
3614
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003615 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3616 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003617 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3618 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3619 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3620 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3621 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3622 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3623 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3624 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003625 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3626
3627 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3628 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3629 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3630 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003631 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003632 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3633 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3634 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3635 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3636 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3637 else
3638 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3639
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003640 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3641 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003642 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003643 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3644 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3645 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3646 }
3647
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003648 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003649 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3650 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003651 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3652 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3653 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003654 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3655
3656 switch (LHSCC) {
3657 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003658 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003659 switch (RHSCC) {
3660 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3662 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3663 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3666 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3669 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003670 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003671 switch (RHSCC) {
3672 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003673 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3674 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3675 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3676 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3678 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3679 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3680 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3681 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3682 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3683 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003684 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003685 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3686 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003687 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003688 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003689 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3690 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003691 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3692 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003693 }
3694 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3695 }
3696 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003697 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003698 switch (RHSCC) {
3699 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3701 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003703 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3704 break;
3705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3706 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3709 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003710 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003711 break;
3712 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003713 switch (RHSCC) {
3714 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3716 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003717 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003718 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3719 break;
3720 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3721 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003722 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3724 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003725 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003726 break;
3727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3728 switch (RHSCC) {
3729 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003730 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003731 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3733 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3734 break;
3735 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3736 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3737 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3738 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3739 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3740 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3741 true, I);
3742 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3743 break;
3744 }
3745 break;
3746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3747 switch (RHSCC) {
3748 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003749 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3753 break;
3754 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3755 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3756 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3757 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3758 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3759 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3760 true, I);
3761 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3762 break;
3763 }
3764 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003765 }
3766 }
3767 }
3768
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003769 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003770 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3771 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3772 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3773 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003774 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003775 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003776 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3777 I.getType(), TD) &&
3778 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3779 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003780 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003781 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3782 I.getName());
3783 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003784 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003785 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003786 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003787
3788 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003789 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3790 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3791 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003792 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3793 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3794 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003795 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003796 SI1->getOperand(0),
3797 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003798 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003799 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003800 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003801 }
3802
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003803 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3804 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3805 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3806 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3807 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3808 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3809 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3810 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3811 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003812 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003813 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3814 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3815 RHS->getOperand(0));
3816 }
3817 }
3818 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003819
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003820 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003821}
3822
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003823/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3824/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3825/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003826static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003827 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3828 if (I == 0) return true;
3829
3830 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3831 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3832 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3833 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3834
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003835 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003836 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3837 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003838 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003839 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003840 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003841 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3842 return true;
3843
3844 unsigned DestNo;
3845 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3846 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3847 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3848 } else {
3849 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3850 DestNo = 0;
3851 }
3852
3853 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3854 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3855 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3856 return true;
3857 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3858 return false;
3859 }
3860
3861 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3862 // don't have this.
3863 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3864 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3865 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3866 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3867 return true;
3868 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3869
3870 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003871 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3872 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003873 return true;
3874
3875 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3876 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003877 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3878 return true;
3879 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003880 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003881 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003882 break;
3883 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3884 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3885
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003886 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003887 unsigned SrcByte;
3888 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3889 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3890 else
3891 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3892
3893 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3894 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3895 return true;
3896
3897 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3898 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3899 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3900 return true;
3901 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3902 return false;
3903}
3904
3905/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3906/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3907Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003908 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3909 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3910 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003911
3912 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3913 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003914 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003915 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003916
3917 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3918 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3919 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3920 return 0;
3921
3922 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3923 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3924 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3925
3926 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3927 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3928 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3929 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003930 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003931 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003932 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003933 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003934}
3935
3936
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003937Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003938 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003939 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003940
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003941 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003943
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003944 // or X, X = X
3945 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003947
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003948 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3949 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003950 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3951 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3952 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3954 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3955 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003956 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3957 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3958 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3959 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3960 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003961 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003962
3963
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003964
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003965 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003966 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003967 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003968 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3969 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003970 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003971 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003972 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003973 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003974 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003975 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003976
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003977 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3978 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003979 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003980 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003981 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003982 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003983 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003984 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003985
3986 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3987 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003988 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003989 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003990 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3991 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3992 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003993 }
3994
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003995 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3996 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003997
3998 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3999 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4001 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4002 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4004
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004005 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4006 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004007 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004008 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4009 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4010 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004011 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4012 return BSwap;
4013 }
4014
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004015 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4016 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004017 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004018 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004019 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4020 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004021 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004022 }
4023
4024 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4025 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004026 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004027 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004028 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4029 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004030 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004031 }
4032
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004033 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004034 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004035 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4036 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004037 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4038 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4039 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4040 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4041 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4042 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4043 // replace with V+N.
4044 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4045 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4046 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4047 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4048 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4049 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4050 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4051 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4052 }
4053 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4054 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4055 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4056 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4057 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4058 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4059 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4060 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4061 }
4062 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004063 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004064 }
4065
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004066 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4067 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004068 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4069 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4070 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4071 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4072 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4073 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4074 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4075 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4076 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4077
4078 if (V1) {
4079 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004080 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4081 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004082 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004083 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004084 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004085
4086 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004087 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4088 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4089 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004090 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4091 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4092 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004093 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004094 SI1->getOperand(0),
4095 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004096 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004097 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004098 }
4099 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004100
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004101 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4102 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004103 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004104 } else {
4105 A = 0;
4106 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004107 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004108 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4109 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004111
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004112 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004113 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004114 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004115 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004116 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004117 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004118 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004119
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004120 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4121 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4122 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004123 return R;
4124
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004125 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4126 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004127 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4128 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4129 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4130 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4131 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4132 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4133 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4134 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004135 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4136 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4137 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004138 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004139 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004140 bool NeedsSwap;
4141 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004142 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004143 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004144 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004145
4146 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004147 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4148 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4149 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4150 }
4151
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004152 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004153 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4154 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004155 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4156 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004157 // equal.
4158 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4159
4160 switch (LHSCC) {
4161 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004162 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004163 switch (RHSCC) {
4164 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004165 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004166 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4167 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004168 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004169 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4170 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004171 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004172 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004173 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004174 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4175 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4176 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004177 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004178 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4179 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4180 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4182 }
4183 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004184 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004185 switch (RHSCC) {
4186 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004187 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4188 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4189 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004190 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004191 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4192 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4193 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004195 }
4196 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004197 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004198 switch (RHSCC) {
4199 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004200 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004201 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004202 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004203 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4204 // this can cause overflow.
4205 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4206 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004207 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4208 false, I);
4209 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4210 break;
4211 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4212 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004214 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4215 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004216 }
4217 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004218 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004219 switch (RHSCC) {
4220 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004221 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4222 break;
4223 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004224 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4225 // this can cause overflow.
4226 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004228 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4229 false, I);
4230 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4231 break;
4232 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4233 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4234 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4235 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4236 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004237 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004238 break;
4239 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4240 switch (RHSCC) {
4241 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4242 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4243 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4245 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4246 break;
4247 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4248 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004250 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4251 break;
4252 }
4253 break;
4254 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4255 switch (RHSCC) {
4256 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4257 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4258 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4260 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4261 break;
4262 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4263 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004265 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4266 break;
4267 }
4268 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004269 }
4270 }
4271 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004272
4273 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004274 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004275 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004276 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004277 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4278 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4279 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4280 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4281 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4282 // generated.
4283 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4284 I.getType(), TD) &&
4285 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4286 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004287 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004288 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4289 I.getName());
4290 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004291 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004292 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004293 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004294 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004295 }
4296
4297
4298 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4299 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4300 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4301 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004302 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4303 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004304 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4305 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4306 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4307 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004308 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4310
4311 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4312 // rest.
4313 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4314 RHS->getOperand(0));
4315 }
4316 }
4317 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004318
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004319 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004320}
4321
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004322namespace {
4323
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004324// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4325struct XorSelf {
4326 Value *RHS;
4327 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4328 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4329 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4330 return &Xor;
4331 }
4332};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004333
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004334}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004335
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004336Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004337 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004338 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004339
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004340 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4341 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4342 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4343 // idiom (misuse).
4344 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004345 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004346 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004347
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004348 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4349 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004350 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004352 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004353
4354 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4355 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004356 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4357 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4358 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4359 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4360 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4361 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004362 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004364 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004365
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004366 // Is this a ~ operation?
4367 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4368 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4369 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4370 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4371 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4372 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4373 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4374 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4375 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004376 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004377 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4378 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4379 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004380 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004381 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004382 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004383 }
4384 }
4385 }
4386 }
4387
4388
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004389 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004390 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4391 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4392 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004393 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4394 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004395
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004396 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4397 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4398 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4399 }
4400
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004401 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4402 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4403 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4404 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4405 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4406 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4407 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4408 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4409 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4410 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4411 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4412 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4413 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4414 }
4415 }
4416 }
4417 }
4418 }
4419
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004420 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004421 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004422 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4423 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004424 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4425 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004426 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004427 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004428 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004429
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004430 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004431 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004432 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004433 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004434 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004435 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004436 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004437 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004438 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004439 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004440 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4441 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004442 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004443
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004444 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004445 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4446 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004447 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004448 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4449 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4450 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004451 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004452 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4453 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004454 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004455 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4456 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4457 return &I;
4458 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004459 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004460 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004461 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004462
4463 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4464 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004465 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004466 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004467 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4468 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4469 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004470 }
4471
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004472 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004473 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004474 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004475
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004476 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004477 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004479
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004480
4481 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4482 if (Op1I) {
4483 Value *A, *B;
4484 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4485 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004486 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004487 I.swapOperands();
4488 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004489 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004490 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004491 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004492 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004493 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4494 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4496 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4498 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004499 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004500 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004501 std::swap(A, B);
4502 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004503 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004504 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4505 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4506 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004507 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004508 }
4509
4510 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4511 if (Op0I) {
4512 Value *A, *B;
4513 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4514 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4515 std::swap(A, B);
4516 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4517 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004518 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4519 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004520 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004521 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4522 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4524 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4525 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4526 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4527 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4528 std::swap(A, B);
4529 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004530 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004531 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004532 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4533 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004534 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004535 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004536 }
4537
4538 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4539 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4540 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4541 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4542 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4543 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004544 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004545 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4546 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004547 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004548 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4549 }
4550
4551 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4552 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4553 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4554 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4555 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4556 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004557 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004558 }
4559 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4560 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4561 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4562 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004563 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004564 }
4565
4566 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4567 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4568 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4569 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4570 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4571 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4572 if (A == C)
4573 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4574 else if (A == D)
4575 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4576 else if (B == C)
4577 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4578 else if (B == D)
4579 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4580
4581 if (X) {
4582 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004583 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4584 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004585 }
4586 }
4587 }
4588
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004589 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4590 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4591 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004592 return R;
4593
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004594 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004595 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004596 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004597 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4598 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004599 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004600 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004601 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4602 I.getType(), TD) &&
4603 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4604 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004605 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004606 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4607 I.getName());
4608 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004609 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004610 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004611 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004612 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004613
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004614 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004615}
4616
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004617/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4618/// overflowed for this type.
4619static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004620 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004621 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004622
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004623 if (IsSigned)
4624 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4625 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4626 else
4627 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4628 else
4629 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004630}
4631
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004632/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4633/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4634/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4635static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4636 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4637 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004638 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4639 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004640
4641 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004642 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004643 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004644
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004645 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4646 ++i, ++GTI) {
4647 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004648 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004649 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4650 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4651
4652 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4653 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4654 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4655
4656 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4657 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004658 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004659 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004660 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004661 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4662 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4663 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004664 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004665
4666 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4667 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4668 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4669 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4670 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4671 else {
4672 // Emit an add instruction.
4673 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004674 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004675 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004676 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004677 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004678 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004679 // Convert to correct type.
4680 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4681 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4682 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4683 else
4684 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4685 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4686 }
4687 if (Size != 1) {
4688 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4689 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4690 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4691 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004692 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004693 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4694 }
4695
4696 // Emit an add instruction.
4697 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4698 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4699 cast<Constant>(Result));
4700 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004701 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004702 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004703 }
4704 return Result;
4705}
4706
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004707
4708/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
4709/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
4710/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
4711/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
4712/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
4713/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
4714/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
4715///
4716/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
4717///
4718static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
4719 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004720 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4721 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4722
4723 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
4724 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
4725 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
4726 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
4727 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
4728 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
4729 int64_t Offset = 0;
4730 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4731 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
4732 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4733 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4734
4735 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4736 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4737 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4738 } else {
4739 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4740 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4741 }
4742 } else {
4743 // Found our variable index.
4744 break;
4745 }
4746 }
4747
4748 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
4749 // evaluate it the general way.
4750 if (i == e) return 0;
4751
4752 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
4753 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
4754 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
4755 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4756
4757 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
4758 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4759 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
4760 if (!CI) return 0;
4761
4762 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4763 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4764
4765 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4766 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4767 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4768 } else {
4769 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4770 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4771 }
4772 }
4773
4774 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
4775 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
4776 // the index.
4777 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
4778 if (Offset == 0) {
4779 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
4780 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
4781 // computation crosses zero.
4782 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
4783 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
4784 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4785 return VariableIdx;
4786 }
4787
4788 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
4789 // the pointer size, so get it.
4790 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
4791
4792 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
4793 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
4794
4795 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
4796 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
4797 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
4798 // multiple of the variable scale.
4799 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
4800 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
4801 return 0;
4802
4803 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
4804 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4805 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004806 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004807 true /*SExt*/,
4808 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4809 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004810 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004811}
4812
4813
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004814/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004815/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004816Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4817 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4818 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004819 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004820
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004821 // Look through bitcasts.
4822 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
4823 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004824
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004825 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4826 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004827 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004828 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
4829 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
4830 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4831
4832 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
4833 if (Offset == 0)
4834 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004835 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4836 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004837 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004838 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4839 // compare the base pointer.
4840 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4841 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004842 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004843 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004844 if (IndicesTheSame)
4845 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4846 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4847 IndicesTheSame = false;
4848 break;
4849 }
4850
4851 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4852 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4854 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004855
4856 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4857 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004858 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004859 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004860
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004861 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4862 bool AllZeros = true;
4863 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4864 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4865 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4866 AllZeros = false;
4867 break;
4868 }
4869 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004870 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4871 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004872
4873 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004874 AllZeros = true;
4875 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4876 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4877 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4878 AllZeros = false;
4879 break;
4880 }
4881 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004882 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004883
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004884 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4885 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4886 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4887 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4888 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4889 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004890 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4891 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004892 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004893 NumDifferences = 2;
4894 break;
4895 } else {
4896 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4897 DiffOperand = i;
4898 }
4899 }
4900
4901 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4902 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004903 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00004904 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004905
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004906 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004907 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4908 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004909 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4910 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004911 }
4912 }
4913
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004914 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004915 // the result to fold to a constant!
4916 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4917 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4918 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4919 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4920 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004921 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004922 }
4923 }
4924 return 0;
4925}
4926
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004927/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
4928///
4929Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
4930 Instruction *LHSI,
4931 Constant *RHSC) {
4932 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
4933 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
4934
4935 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
4936 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00004937 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004938 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
4939
4940 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
4941 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
4942 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
4943 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4944
4945 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
4946 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
4947 ++InputSize;
4948
4949 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
4950 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
4951 return 0;
4952
4953 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
4954 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
4955 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
4956 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
4957
4958 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
4959 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4960 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
4961 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
4962 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
4963 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
4964 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
4965 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
4966 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
4967 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
4968 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
4969 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
4970 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
4971 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
4972 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
4973 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
4974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4975 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
4976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4977 }
4978
4979 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
4980
4981 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
4982
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00004983 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004984 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
4985 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4986
4987 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
4988 // and large values.
4989 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
4990 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
4991 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
4992 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00004993 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
4994 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004995 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4997 }
4998
4999 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5000 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5001 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5002 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5003 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005004 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5005 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005006 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5007 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5008 }
5009
5010 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
5011 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
5012 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
5013 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
5014 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5015 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5016 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
5017 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5018 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5019 // zero at this point.
5020 switch (Pred) {
5021 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5022 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5026 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5027 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5028 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5029 if (RHS.isNegative())
5030 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5031 break;
5032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5033 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5034 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5035 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5036 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5037 break;
5038 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5039 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5040 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5041 if (RHS.isNegative())
5042 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5043 break;
5044 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5045 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5046 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5047 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5048 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5049 break;
5050 }
5051 }
5052
5053 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5054 // comparison.
5055 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5056}
5057
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005058Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5059 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005060 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005061
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005062 // Fold trivial predicates.
5063 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5064 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5065 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5067
5068 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5069 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5070 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5071 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5072 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5073 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5074 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5075 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5076 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5077 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5078 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5080
5081 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5082 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5083 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5084 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5085 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5086 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5087 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5088 return &I;
5089
5090 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5091 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5092 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5093 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5094 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5095 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5096 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5097 return &I;
5098 }
5099 }
5100
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005101 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005102 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005103
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005104 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5105 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005106 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5107 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5108 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5109 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005111 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5112 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5113 // True if unordered.
5114 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005115 }
5116 }
5117
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005118 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5119 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5120 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005121 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5122 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5123 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5124 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5125 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5126 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005127 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005128 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5129 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5130 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5131 return NV;
5132 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005133 case Instruction::Select:
5134 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5135 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5136 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5137 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5138 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5139 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5140 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5141 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5142 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5143 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5144 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5145 I.getName()), I);
5146 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5147 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5148 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5149 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5150 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5151 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5152 I.getName()), I);
5153 }
5154 }
5155
5156 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005157 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005158 break;
5159 }
5160 }
5161
5162 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5163}
5164
5165Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5166 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5167 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5168 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5169
5170 // icmp X, X
5171 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005173 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005174
5175 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005177
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005178 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005179 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005180 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5181 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5182 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005183 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005185 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005186
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005187 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005188 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005189 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5190 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005191 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005192 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005193 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005194 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005195 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005196 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005197 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005198
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005199 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005200 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005201 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005202 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005203 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005204 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005205 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005206 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005207 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5208 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005209 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005210 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5211 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5212 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5213 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5214 }
5215 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5216 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5217 // FALL THROUGH
5218 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005219 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005220 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005221 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005222 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005223 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5224 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5225 // FALL THROUGH
5226 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5227 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5228 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5229 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5230 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005231 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005232 }
5233
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00005234 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5235 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005236 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005237 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005238
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005239 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5240 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5241 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5242 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5243 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005244 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005245
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005246 // If we have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the appropriate
5247 // icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on them being
5248 // folded in the code below.
5249 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5250 default: break;
5251 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5252 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5254 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5255 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5256 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5258 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5259 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5260 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5261 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5262 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5263 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5264 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5266 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5267 }
5268
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005269 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5270 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5271 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5272 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5273
5274 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005275 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005276 bool UnusedBit;
5277 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5278
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005279 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5280 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5281 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005282 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5283 return &I;
5284
5285 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005286 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5287 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5288 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005289 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5290 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5291 else
5292 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5293
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005294 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5295 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5296 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5297 if (Min == Max)
5298 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5299 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5300 CI));
5301
5302 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5303 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5304 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005305 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5306 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5307 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5308 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5310 break;
5311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5312 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5313 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5314 break;
5315 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005316 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005317 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005318 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005319 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005320 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5321 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5322 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5323 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5324
5325 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5326 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5327 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5328 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005329 break;
5330 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005331 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005333 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005334 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005335
5336 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5337 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5338 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5339 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5340
5341 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5342 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5343 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5344 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005345 break;
5346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005347 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005349 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005351 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5352 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005353 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005354 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005355 break;
5356 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005357 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005359 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005361
5362 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5363 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5364 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5365 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005366 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005367 }
5368
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005369 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005370 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005371 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005372 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005373 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5374 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005375 }
5376
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005377 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005378 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5379 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5380 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005381 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5382 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005383 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005384 bool isAllZeros = true;
5385 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5386 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5387 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5388 isAllZeros = false;
5389 break;
5390 }
5391 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005392 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005393 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5394 }
5395 break;
5396
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005397 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005398 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5399 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5400 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5401 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5402 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5403 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005404 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005405 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005406 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5407 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5408 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5409 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5410 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5411 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5412 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005413 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5414 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5415 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5416 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5417 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005418 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5419 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005420 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5421 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5422 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5423 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5424 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005425 }
5426 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005427
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005428 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005429 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005430 break;
5431 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005432 case Instruction::Malloc:
5433 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5434 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5435 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5436 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005438 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005439 }
5440 break;
5441 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005442 }
5443
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005444 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005445 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005446 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005447 return NI;
5448 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005449 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5450 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005451 return NI;
5452
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005453 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005454 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5455 // now.
5456 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5457 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5458 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005459 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5460 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005461 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005462
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005463 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5464 // so eliminate it as well.
5465 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5466 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005467
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005468 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005469 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005470 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005471 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005472 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005473 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005474 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005475 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005476 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005477 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005478 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005479 }
5480
5481 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005482 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005483 // This comes up when you have code like
5484 // int X = A < B;
5485 // if (X) ...
5486 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005487 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5488 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005489 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005490 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005491 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005492
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005493 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5494 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5495 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005496 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5497 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5498 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005499 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005500 default: break;
5501 case Instruction::Add:
5502 case Instruction::Sub:
5503 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005504 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5505 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5506 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005507 break;
5508 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005509 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5510 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5511 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5512 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5513 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5514 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5515 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5516 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005517 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005518 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5519 Mask);
5520 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5521 Mask);
5522 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5523 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5524 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005525 }
5526 }
5527 break;
5528 }
5529 }
5530 }
5531 }
5532
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005533 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5534 { Value *A, *B;
5535 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5536 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5537 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5538 }
5539
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005540 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005541 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005542
5543 // -x == -y --> x == y
5544 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5545 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5546 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5547
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005548 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5549 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5550 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5551 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5552 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5553 }
5554
5555 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5556 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5557 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5558 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5559 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005560 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005561 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005562 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5563 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5564 }
5565
5566 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5567 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5568 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5569 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5570 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5571 }
5572 }
5573
5574 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5575 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005576 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5577 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005578 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5579 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005580 }
5581 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005582 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005583 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5584 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005585 }
5586 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005587 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005588 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5589 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005590 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005591
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005592 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5593 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5594 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5595 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5596 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5597
5598 if (A == C) {
5599 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5600 } else if (A == D) {
5601 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5602 } else if (B == C) {
5603 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5604 } else if (B == D) {
5605 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5606 }
5607
5608 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005609 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5610 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005611 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5612 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5613 return &I;
5614 }
5615 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005616 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005617 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005618}
5619
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005620
5621/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5622/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5623Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5624 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5625 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5626 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5627
5628 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5629 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5630 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5631 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5632 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5633 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5634 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5635 // if it finds it.
5636 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5637 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5638 return 0;
5639 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005640 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005641
5642 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5643 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5644 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5645 // instead of computing a divide.
5646 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5647
5648 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5649 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5650 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5651 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5652 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5653
5654 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005655 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005656
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005657 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5658 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5659 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5660 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5661 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5662 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5663 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5664 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5665 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5666
5667
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005668 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005669 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005670 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005671 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5672 if (!HiOverflow)
5673 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005674 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005675 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005676 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005677 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5678 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005679 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005680 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5681 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5682 if (!HiOverflow)
5683 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005684 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005685 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005686 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5687 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005688 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005689 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005690 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005691 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005692 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005693 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005694 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005695 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5696 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005697 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5698 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5699 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5700 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005701 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005702 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5703 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005704 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005705 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005706 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5707 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005708 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005709 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005710 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005711 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5712 }
5713
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005714 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5715 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005716 }
5717
5718 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005719 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005720 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5721 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5722 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5724 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005725 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005726 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5727 else if (LoOverflow)
5728 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5729 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5730 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005731 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005732 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5733 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5735 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005736 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005737 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5738 else if (LoOverflow)
5739 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5740 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5741 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005742 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5744 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005745 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5747 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005748 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005749 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5751 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005752 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005754 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5756 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005757 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5758 else
5759 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5760 }
5761}
5762
5763
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005764/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5765///
5766Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5767 Instruction *LHSI,
5768 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5769 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5770
5771 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005772 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005773 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5774 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5775 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005776 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
5777 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005778 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5779
5780 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5781 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5782 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5783 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5784 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5785 return &ICI;
5786 }
5787
5788 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5789 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5790
5791 // If so, the new one isn't.
5792 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5793
5794 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5795 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5796 else
5797 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5798 }
5799 }
5800 break;
5801 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5802 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5803 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5804 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5805
5806 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5807 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5808 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5809 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5810 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5811 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5812 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5813 // bit would not work.
5814 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00005815 (ICI.isEquality() ||
5816 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005817 uint32_t BitWidth =
5818 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5819 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5820 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5821 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5822 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5823 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005824 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005825 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5826 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5827 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5828 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5829 }
5830 }
5831
5832 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5833 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5834 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5835 // access.
5836 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5837 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5838 Shift = 0;
5839
5840 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5841 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5842 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5843 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5844
5845 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5846 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5847 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5848 if (ShAmt) {
5849 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5850 if (!CanFold) {
5851 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5852 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5853 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5854 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5855
5856 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5857 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5858 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5859 CanFold = true;
5860 }
5861
5862 if (CanFold) {
5863 Constant *NewCst;
5864 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5865 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5866 else
5867 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5868
5869 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5870 // compared.
5871 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5872 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5873 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5874 // result is always true or false now.
5875 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5877 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5879 } else {
5880 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5881 Constant *NewAndCST;
5882 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5883 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5884 else
5885 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5886 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5887 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5888 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5889 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5890 return &ICI;
5891 }
5892 }
5893 }
5894
5895 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5896 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5897 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5898 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5899 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5900 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5901 // Compute C << Y.
5902 Value *NS;
5903 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005904 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005905 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5906 } else {
5907 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005908 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005909 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5910 }
5911 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5912
5913 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5914 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005915 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005916 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5917
5918 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5919 return &ICI;
5920 }
5921 }
5922 break;
5923
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005924 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5925 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5926 if (!ShAmt) break;
5927
5928 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5929
5930 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5931 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5932 // simplified.
5933 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5934 break;
5935
5936 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5937 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5938 // comparison cannot succeed.
5939 Constant *Comp =
5940 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5941 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5942 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5943 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5945 }
5946
5947 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5948 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5949 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5950 Constant *Mask =
5951 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005952
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005953 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005954 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005955 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5956 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5957 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5958 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005959 }
5960 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005961
5962 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5963 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5964 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5965 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5966 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5967 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5968 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5969 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005970 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005971 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5972 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5973
5974 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5975 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5976 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005977 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005978 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005979
5980 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005981 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005982 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005983 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005984 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005985
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005986 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5987 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5988 // simplified.
5989 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5990 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5991 break;
5992
5993 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005994
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00005995 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5996 // comparison cannot succeed.
5997 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5998 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5999 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6000 else
6001 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6002
6003 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6004 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6005 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6006 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6007 }
6008
6009 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6010 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6011 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006012 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6013 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006014 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6015 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6016 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6017 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006018
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006019 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006020 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6021 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6022 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006023
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006024 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006025 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006026 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6027 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6028 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6029 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006030 }
6031 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006032 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006033
6034 case Instruction::SDiv:
6035 case Instruction::UDiv:
6036 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6037 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6038 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6039 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6040 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6041 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006042 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6043 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6044 DivRHS))
6045 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006046 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006047
6048 case Instruction::Add:
6049 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6050
6051 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6052 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6053 if (!LHSC) break;
6054 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6055
6056 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6057 .subtract(LHSV);
6058
6059 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6060 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6061 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6062 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6063 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6064 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6065 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6066 }
6067 } else {
6068 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6069 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6070 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6071 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6072 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6073 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6074 }
6075 }
6076 }
6077 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006078 }
6079
6080 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6081 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6082 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6083
6084 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6085 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6086 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6087 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6088 case Instruction::SRem:
6089 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6090 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6091 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6092 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6093 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006094 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006095 BO->getName());
6096 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6097 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6098 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6099 }
6100 }
6101 break;
6102 case Instruction::Add:
6103 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6104 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6105 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6106 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6107 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6108 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6109 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6110 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6111 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6112
6113 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6114 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6115 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6116 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6117 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006118 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006119 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6120 Neg->takeName(BO);
6121 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6122 }
6123 }
6124 break;
6125 case Instruction::Xor:
6126 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6127 // the explicit xor.
6128 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6129 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6130 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6131
6132 // FALLTHROUGH
6133 case Instruction::Sub:
6134 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6135 if (RHSV == 0)
6136 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6137 BO->getOperand(1));
6138 break;
6139
6140 case Instruction::Or:
6141 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6142 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6143 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6144 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6145 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6147 isICMP_NE));
6148 }
6149 break;
6150
6151 case Instruction::And:
6152 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6153 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6154 // comparison can never succeed!
6155 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6157 isICMP_NE));
6158
6159 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6160 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6161 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6162 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6163 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6164
6165 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006166 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006167 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6168 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6169 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6170 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6171 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6172 }
6173
6174 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6175 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6176 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6177 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6178 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6179 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6180 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6181 }
6182 }
6183 default: break;
6184 }
6185 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6186 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6187 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6188 AddToWorkList(II);
6189 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6190 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6191 return &ICI;
6192 }
6193 }
6194 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006195 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6196 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006197 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6198 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6199 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6200 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6201 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6202 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6203 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6204 // smaller constant values.
6205 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6206 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6207 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6208 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6209 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6210 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6211 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6212 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6213 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6214 }
6215 }
6216 }
6217 }
6218 return 0;
6219}
6220
6221/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6222/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6223///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006224Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6225 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006226 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6227 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006228 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006229 Value *RHSCIOp;
6230
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006231 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6232 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6233 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6234 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6235 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6236 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6237 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006238 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006239 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6240 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6241 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6242 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006243 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006244 }
6245
6246 if (RHSOp)
6247 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6248 }
6249
6250 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6251 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006252 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6253 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006254 return 0;
6255
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006256 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6257 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006258
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006259 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006260 // Not an extension from the same type?
6261 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006262 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6263 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006264
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006265 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006266 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6267 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6268 return 0;
6269
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006270 // Deal with equality cases early.
6271 if (ICI.isEquality())
6272 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6273
6274 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6275 // signed comparison.
6276 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6277 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6278
6279 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6280 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006281 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006282
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006283 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6284 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6285 if (!CI)
6286 return 0;
6287
6288 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6289 // reextended to DestTy.
6290 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6291 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6292
6293 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6294 if (Res2 == CI) {
6295 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6296 // For example, we might have:
6297 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6298 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6299 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6300 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6301 // because %A may have negative value.
6302 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006303 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6304 // signless.
6305 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006306 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006307 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006308 }
6309
6310 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6311 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6312
6313 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6314 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6315 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006317 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006318 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006319
6320 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6321 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6322 Value *Result;
6323 if (isSignedCmp) {
6324 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006325 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006326 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006327 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006328 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006329 } else {
6330 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6331 if (isSignedExt) {
6332 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6333 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006334 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006335 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6336 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6337 } else {
6338 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006339 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006340 }
6341 }
6342
6343 // Finally, return the value computed.
6344 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006345 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006347
6348 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6349 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6350 "ICmp should be folded!");
6351 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6353 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006354}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006355
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006356Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6357 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6358}
6359
6360Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6361 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6362}
6363
6364Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006365 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6366 return R;
6367
6368 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6369
6370 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6371 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6372 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6374
6375 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006376 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6377 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006378 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006379 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006380
6381 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006382}
6383
6384Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6385 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006386 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006387
6388 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6389 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006390 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006391 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006393
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006394 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6395 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006396 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006397 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6399 }
6400 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006401 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6403 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006405 }
6406
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006407 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6408 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6409 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006410 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006411 return R;
6412
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006413 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006414 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6415 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006416 return 0;
6417}
6418
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006419Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006420 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006421 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006422
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006423 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6424 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006425 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6426 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6427 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006428 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6429 return &I;
6430
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006431 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6432 // of a signed value.
6433 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006434 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006435 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006436 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6437 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006438 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006439 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006440 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006441 }
6442
6443 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6444 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6445 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6446 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006447 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006448 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6449
6450 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6451 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6452 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6453 return R;
6454 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6455 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6456 return NV;
6457
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006458 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6459 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6460 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6461 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6462 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6463 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6464 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6465 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6466 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6467 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6468 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6469 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006470 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006471 I.getName());
6472 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6473
6474 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6475 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6476 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6477 // other xforms later if dead.
6478 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6479 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6480 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6481
6482 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6483 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6484 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6485 // mask as appropriate.
6486 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6487 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6488 else {
6489 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6490 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6491 }
6492
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006493 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006494 TI->getName());
6495 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6496
6497 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6498 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6499 }
6500 }
6501
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006502 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006503 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6504 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6505 Value *V1, *V2;
6506 ConstantInt *CC;
6507 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006508 default: break;
6509 case Instruction::Add:
6510 case Instruction::And:
6511 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006512 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006513 // These operators commute.
6514 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006515 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6516 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006517 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006518 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006519 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006520 Op0BO->getName());
6521 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006522 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006523 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006524 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006525 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006526 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006527 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006528 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006529 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006530
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006531 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006532 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006533 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006534 match(Op0BOOp1,
6535 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006536 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6537 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006538 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006539 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6540 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006541 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6542 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006543 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006544 V1->getName()+".mask");
6545 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6546
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006547 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006548 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006549 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006550
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006551 // FALL THROUGH.
6552 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006553 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006554 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6555 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006556 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006557 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006558 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6559 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006560 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006561 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006562 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006563 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006564 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006565 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006566 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006567 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006568 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006569
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006570 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006571 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6572 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6573 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006574 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006575 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6576 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006577 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006578 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6579 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006580 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6581 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006582 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006583 V1->getName()+".mask");
6584 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6585
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006586 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006587 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006588
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006589 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006590 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006591 }
6592
6593
6594 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6595 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6596 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6597 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6598 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6599
6600 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006601 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006602 case Instruction::Add:
6603 isValid = isLeftShift;
6604 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006605 case Instruction::Or:
6606 case Instruction::Xor:
6607 highBitSet = false;
6608 break;
6609 case Instruction::And:
6610 highBitSet = true;
6611 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006612 }
6613
6614 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6615 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6616 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6617 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6618 // operation.
6619 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006620 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006621 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006622
6623 if (isValid) {
6624 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6625
6626 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006627 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006628 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006629 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006630
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006631 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006632 NewRHS);
6633 }
6634 }
6635 }
6636 }
6637
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006638 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006639 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6640 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6641 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006642
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006643 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006644 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006645 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6646 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006647 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6648 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6649 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006650
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006651 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006652 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6653 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006654
6655 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6656
6657 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006658 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006659 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006660 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6661 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6662 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6663 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006664 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006665 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6666 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6667 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6668 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006669 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006670 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6671
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006672 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006673 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006674 }
6675
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006676 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6677 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6678 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6679 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6680 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006681 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006682 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006683 }
6684 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6685 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006686 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006687 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006688 }
6689 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6690 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6691 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6692 // generators.
6693 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6694 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006695 case 1 :
6696 case 8 :
6697 case 16 :
6698 case 32 :
6699 case 64 :
6700 case 128:
6701 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6702 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006703 default: break;
6704 }
6705 if (SExtType) {
6706 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6707 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6708 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6709 }
6710 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6711 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006712 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006713
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006714 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006715 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6716 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6717 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006718 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006719 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006720 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6721
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006722 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006723 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006724 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006725
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006726 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006727 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6728 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6729 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006730 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006731 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006732
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006733 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006734 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006735 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006736
6737 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6738 } else {
6739 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006740 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006741
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006742 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006743 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6744 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6745 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6746 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006747 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006748 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6749 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6750
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006751 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006752 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006753 }
6754
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006755 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006756 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6757 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6758 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006759 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006760 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6761
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006762 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006763 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006764 }
6765
6766 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006767 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006768 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006769 return 0;
6770}
6771
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006772
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006773/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6774/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6775/// X*Scale+Offset.
6776///
6777static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006778 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006779 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006780 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006781 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006782 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006783 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006784 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6785 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6786 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6787 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6788 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6789 Offset = 0;
6790 return I->getOperand(0);
6791 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6792 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6793 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6794 Offset = 0;
6795 return I->getOperand(0);
6796 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6797 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6798 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6799 unsigned SubScale;
6800 Value *SubVal =
6801 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6802 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6803 Scale = SubScale;
6804 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006805 }
6806 }
6807 }
6808
6809 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6810 Scale = 1;
6811 Offset = 0;
6812 return Val;
6813}
6814
6815
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006816/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6817/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006818Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006819 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006820 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006821
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006822 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6823 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006824
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006825 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6826 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6827 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6828 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6829 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6830
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006831 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006832 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006833 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006834 }
6835 }
6836
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006837 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6838 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6839 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6840 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006841
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006842 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6843 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006844 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6845
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006846 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6847 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6848 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6849 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6850
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006851 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6852 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006853 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006854
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006855 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6856 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006857 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6858 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006859 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6860 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6861
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006862 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6863 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006864 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6865 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006866
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006867 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6868 Value *Amt = 0;
6869 if (Scale == 1) {
6870 Amt = NumElements;
6871 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006872 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006873 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6874 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006875 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006876 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006877 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006878 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006879 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006880 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006881 }
6882
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006883 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6884 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006885 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006886 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6887 }
6888
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006889 AllocationInst *New;
6890 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006891 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006892 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006893 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006894 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006895 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006896
6897 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6898 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6899 // die soon.
6900 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6901 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006902 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6903 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6904 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006905 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6906 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6907 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6909}
6910
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006911/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006912/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6913/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6914/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6915/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6916///
6917/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6918/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006919///
6920/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
6921/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
6922/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
6923/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
6924/// efficiently truncated.
6925///
6926/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
6927/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
6928/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00006929bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
6930 unsigned CastOpc,
6931 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006932 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6933 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6934 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006935
6936 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006937 if (!I) return false;
6938
6939 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006940
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006941 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6942 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6943 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6944 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6945 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6946 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6947 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6948 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006949 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006950 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6951 return true;
6952 }
6953 }
6954
6955 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6956 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6957 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6958
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006959 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006960 case Instruction::Add:
6961 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00006962 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006963 case Instruction::And:
6964 case Instruction::Or:
6965 case Instruction::Xor:
6966 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006967 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6968 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6969 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6970 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006971
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006972 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006973 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6974 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6975 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006976 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6977 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6978 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006979 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6980 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006981 }
6982 break;
6983 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006984 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6985 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6986 // already zeros.
6987 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006988 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6989 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6990 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006991 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006992 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6993 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006994 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6995 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006996 }
6997 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006998 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006999 case Instruction::ZExt:
7000 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007001 case Instruction::Trunc:
7002 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007003 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7004 // of casts in the input.
7005 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007006 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007007 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007008 case Instruction::Select: {
7009 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7010 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7011 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7012 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7013 NumCastsRemoved);
7014 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007015 case Instruction::PHI: {
7016 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7017 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7018 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7019 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7020 NumCastsRemoved))
7021 return false;
7022 return true;
7023 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007024 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007025 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7026 break;
7027 }
7028
7029 return false;
7030}
7031
7032/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7033/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7034/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007035Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007036 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007037 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007038 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007039
7040 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7041 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007042 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007043 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007044 case Instruction::Add:
7045 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007046 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007047 case Instruction::And:
7048 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007049 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007050 case Instruction::AShr:
7051 case Instruction::LShr:
7052 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007053 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007054 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007055 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007056 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007057 break;
7058 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007059 case Instruction::Trunc:
7060 case Instruction::ZExt:
7061 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007062 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007063 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7064 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007065 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7066 return I->getOperand(0);
7067
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007068 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007069 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007070 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007071 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007072 case Instruction::Select: {
7073 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7074 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7075 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7076 break;
7077 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007078 case Instruction::PHI: {
7079 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7080 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7081 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7082 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7083 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7084 }
7085 Res = NPN;
7086 break;
7087 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007088 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007089 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7090 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7091 break;
7092 }
7093
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007094 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007095 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7096}
7097
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007098/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7099Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007100 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7101
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007102 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007103 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007104 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007105 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7106 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7107 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7108 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007109 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007110 }
7111 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007112
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007113 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007114 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7115 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7116 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007117
7118 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007119 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7120 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7121 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007122
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007123 return 0;
7124}
7125
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007126/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7127Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7128 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7129
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007130 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007131 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7132 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007133 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7134 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7135 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7136 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007137 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007138 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7139 return &CI;
7140 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007141
7142 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7143 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7144 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7145 // non-type-safe code.
7146 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7147 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7148 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7149 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7150 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7151
7152 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7153 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7154 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7155 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7156 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7157 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7158
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007159 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7160 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7161 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007162 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007163 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007164 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007165 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7166 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007167
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007168 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7169 if (Offset < 0) {
7170 --FirstIdx;
7171 Offset += TySize;
7172 assert(Offset >= 0);
7173 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007174 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007175 }
7176
7177 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007178
7179 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7180 while (Offset) {
7181 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7182 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007183 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7184 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7185 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007186
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007187 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7188 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7189 } else {
7190 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7191 Offset = 0;
7192 OrigBase = 0;
7193 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007194 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7195 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007196 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007197 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7198 Offset %= EltSize;
7199 } else {
7200 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7201 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007202 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7203 } else {
7204 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7205 Offset = 0;
7206 OrigBase = 0;
7207 }
7208 }
7209 if (OrigBase) {
7210 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7211 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7212 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007213 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7214 NewIndices.begin(),
7215 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007216 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7217 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7218
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007219 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7220 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7221 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7222 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7223 }
7224 }
7225 }
7226 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007227 }
7228
7229 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7230}
7231
7232
7233
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007234/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7235/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007236/// cases.
7237/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7238Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7239 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7240 return Result;
7241
7242 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7243 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7244 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007245 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7246 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007247
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007248 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7249 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007250 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7251 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007252 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7253 return &CI;
7254
7255 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7256 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007257 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7258 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007259 return 0;
7260
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007261 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007262 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007263 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7264 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007265 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007266 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007267 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7268 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7269 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7270 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007271 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007272 bool DoXForm;
7273 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7274 default:
7275 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7276 // get here because of the check above.
7277 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7278 case Instruction::Trunc:
7279 DoXForm = true;
7280 break;
7281 case Instruction::ZExt:
7282 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7283 break;
7284 case Instruction::SExt:
7285 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7286 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007287 }
7288
7289 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007290 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7291 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007292 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7293 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7294 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7295 case Instruction::Trunc:
7296 case Instruction::BitCast:
7297 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7298 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7299 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7300 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7301 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007302 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7303 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007304 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007305 }
7306 case Instruction::SExt:
7307 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007308 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007309 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7310 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007311 }
7312 }
7313 }
7314
7315 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7316 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7317
7318 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7319 case Instruction::Add:
7320 case Instruction::Mul:
7321 case Instruction::And:
7322 case Instruction::Or:
7323 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007324 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007325 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7326 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7327 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7328 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7329 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007330 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7331 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007332 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007333 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7334 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007335 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007336 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007337 }
7338 }
7339
7340 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7341 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7342 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007343 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007344 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007345 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007346 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007347 }
7348 break;
7349 case Instruction::SDiv:
7350 case Instruction::UDiv:
7351 case Instruction::SRem:
7352 case Instruction::URem:
7353 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7354 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7355 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7356 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7357 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007358 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7359 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007360 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7361 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7362 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7363 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007364 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007365 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7366 }
7367 }
7368 break;
7369
7370 case Instruction::Shl:
7371 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7372 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7373 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7374 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7375 // in the value.
7376 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7377 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007378 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7379 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7380 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007381 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007382 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007383 }
7384 break;
7385 case Instruction::AShr:
7386 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7387 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7388 // simplifications.
7389 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7390 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007391 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007392 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7393 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007394 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007395 }
7396 }
7397 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007398 }
7399 return 0;
7400}
7401
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007402Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007403 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7404 return Result;
7405
7406 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7407 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007408 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7409 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007410
7411 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7412 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7413 default: break;
7414 case Instruction::LShr:
7415 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7416 // are already zeros.
7417 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007418 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007419
7420 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007421 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007422 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7423 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007424 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7425 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7426
7427 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7428 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007429 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7430 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7431 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007432 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007433 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007434 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7435
7436 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7437 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7438 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007439 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007440 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7441
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007442 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007443 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007444 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007445 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007446 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7447 "tmp"), CI);
7448 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007449 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007450 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007451 }
7452 break;
7453 }
7454 }
7455
7456 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007457}
7458
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007459/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7460/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7461Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7462 bool DoXform) {
7463 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7464 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7465 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7466 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7467 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7468
7469 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7470 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7471 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7472 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7473 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7474
7475 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7476 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7477 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007478 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007479 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7480 CI);
7481 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007482 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007483 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7484
7485 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7486 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007487 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007488 In->getName()+".not"),
7489 CI);
7490 }
7491
7492 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7493 }
7494
7495
7496
7497 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7498 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7499 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7500 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7501 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7502 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7503 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7504 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7505 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7506 // This only works for EQ and NE
7507 ICI->isEquality()) {
7508 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7509 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7510 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7511 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7512 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7513
7514 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7515 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7516 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7517
7518 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7519 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7520 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7521 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7522 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7523 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7524 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7525 }
7526
7527 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7528 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7529 if (ShiftAmt) {
7530 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7531 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007532 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007533 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7534 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7535 }
7536
7537 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7538 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007539 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007540 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7541 }
7542
7543 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7545 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007546 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007547 }
7548 }
7549 }
7550
7551 return 0;
7552}
7553
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007554Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007555 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7556 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7557 return Result;
7558
7559 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7560
7561 // If this is a cast of a cast
7562 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007563 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7564 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7565 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7566 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7567 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7568 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007569 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7570 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7571 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007572 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7573 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7574 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007575 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007576 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007577 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007578 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007579 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7580 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7581 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7582 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007583 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007584 }
7585 return And;
7586 }
7587 }
7588 }
7589
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007590 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7591 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007592
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007593 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7594 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7595 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7596 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7597 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7598 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7599 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7600 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7601 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7602 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7603 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007604 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007605 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007606 }
7607
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007608 return 0;
7609}
7610
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007611Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007612 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7613 return I;
7614
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007615 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7616
7617 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7618 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7619 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7620 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7621 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7622 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7623 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7624 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7625
7626 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7627 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7628 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7629 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7630 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7631 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7632 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007633 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007634 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007635 CI);
7636 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007637 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007638 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7639
7640 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007641 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007642 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7643
7644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7645 }
7646 }
7647 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007648
7649 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7650 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7651 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7652 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7653 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7654 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7655 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7656 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7657
7658 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7659 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7660 // bits, it is already ready.
7661 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7663 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7664 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7665 // bits, just sext from i32.
7666 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7667 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7668 } else {
7669 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
7670 // bits, just truncate to i32.
7671 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7672 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7673 }
7674 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00007675
7676 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
7677 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
7678 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
7679 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
7680 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
7681 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
7682 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
7683 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
7684 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
7685 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
7686 // into:
7687 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
7688 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
7689 Value *A = 0;
7690 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
7691 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
7692 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
7693 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
7694 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
7695 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7696 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7697 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7698 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
7699 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
7700 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
7701 CI.getName()), CI);
7702 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
7703 }
7704 }
7705
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007706 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007707}
7708
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007709/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
7710/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007711static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007712 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
7713 if (F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven) == APFloat::opOK)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007714 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007715 return 0;
7716}
7717
7718/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
7719/// through it until we get the source value.
7720static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
7721 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
7722 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
7723 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
7724
7725 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
7726 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
7727 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
7728 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
7729 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
7730 return V; // No constant folding of this.
7731 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007732 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007733 return V;
7734 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
7735 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007736 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007737 return V;
7738 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
7739 }
7740
7741 return V;
7742}
7743
7744Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
7745 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7746 return I;
7747
7748 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
7749 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
7750 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
7751 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
7752 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
7753 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
7754 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
7755 default: break;
7756 case Instruction::Add:
7757 case Instruction::Sub:
7758 case Instruction::Mul:
7759 case Instruction::FDiv:
7760 case Instruction::FRem:
7761 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
7762 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
7763 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
7764 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
7765 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
7766 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7767 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
7768 // the cast, do this xform.
7769 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
7770 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
7771 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
7772 CI.getType(), CI);
7773 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
7774 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007775 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007776 }
7777 }
7778 break;
7779 }
7780 }
7781 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007782}
7783
7784Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7785 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7786}
7787
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007788Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007789 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7790 if (OpI == 0)
7791 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7792
7793 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
7794 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
7795 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7796 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7797 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7798 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7799 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7800 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7801 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
7802 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7803 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007804
7805 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007806}
7807
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007808Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007809 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7810 if (OpI == 0)
7811 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7812
7813 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
7814 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
7815 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7816 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7817 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7818 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7819 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7820 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7821 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
7822 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007824
7825 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007826}
7827
7828Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7829 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7830}
7831
7832Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7833 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7834}
7835
7836Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007837 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007838}
7839
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007840Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
7841 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7842 return I;
7843
7844 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
7845 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
7846
7847 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
7848 ConstantInt *Cst;
7849 Value *X;
7850 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
7851 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7852 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
7853 // is a single-index GEP.
7854 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7855 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00007856 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007857
7858 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7859 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7860 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7861
7862 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7863 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7864 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007865 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007866 }
7867 }
7868 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
7869 // struct etc.
7870 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7871 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7872 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
7873 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
7874
7875 // Get the size of the pointee type.
7876 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
7877
7878 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7879 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7880 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7881
7882 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7883 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7884 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
7885
7886 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
7887 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007888 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007889 }
7890 }
7891 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007892}
7893
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007894Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007895 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7896 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7897 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7898 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7899 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7900
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007901 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007902 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7903 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007904 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7905 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7906 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007907 } else {
7908 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7909 return Result;
7910 }
7911
7912
7913 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7914 // be replaced by the operand.
7915 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7916 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7917
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007918 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007919 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7920 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7921 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7922
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00007923 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
7924 // required for changing types.
7925 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
7926 return 0;
7927
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007928 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7929 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7930 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7931 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7932 return V;
7933
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007934 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7935 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007936 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7937 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7938 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7939 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7940 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7941 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7942 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7943 ++NumZeros;
7944 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007945
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007946 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7947 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7948 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007949 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7950 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007951 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007952 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007953
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007954 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7955 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7956 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7957 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007958 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7959 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007960 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7961 CastInst *Tmp;
7962 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7963 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7964 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7965 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7966 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7967 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7968 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007969 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7970 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7971 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7972 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007973 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7974 // know the vector types match #elts.
7975 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007976 }
7977 }
7978 }
7979 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007980 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007981}
7982
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007983/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7984/// %C = or %A, %B
7985/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7986/// into:
7987/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7988/// %D = or %A, %C
7989///
7990/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7991/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7992/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7993///
7994static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7995 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7996 case Instruction::Add:
7997 case Instruction::Mul:
7998 case Instruction::And:
7999 case Instruction::Or:
8000 case Instruction::Xor:
8001 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8002 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8003 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008004 case Instruction::LShr:
8005 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008006 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008007 default:
8008 return 0; // Cannot fold
8009 }
8010}
8011
8012/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8013/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8014static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8015 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8016 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8017 case Instruction::Add:
8018 case Instruction::Sub:
8019 case Instruction::Or:
8020 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008021 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008022 case Instruction::LShr:
8023 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008024 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008025 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008026 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008027 case Instruction::Mul:
8028 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8029 }
8030}
8031
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008032/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8033/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8034Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8035 Instruction *FI) {
8036 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8037 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8038 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008039 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008040 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8041 return 0;
8042 } else {
8043 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8044 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008045
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008046 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008047 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8048 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008049 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008050 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008051 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008052 }
8053
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008054 // Only handle binary operators here.
8055 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008056 return 0;
8057
8058 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8059 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8060 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8061 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8062 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8063 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8064 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8065 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8066 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8067 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8068 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8069 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8070 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8071 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8072 return 0;
8073 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8074 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8075 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8076 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8077 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8078 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8079 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8080 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8081 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8082 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8083 } else {
8084 return 0;
8085 }
8086
8087 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008088 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8089 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008090 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8091
8092 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8093 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008094 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008095 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008096 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008097 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008098 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8099 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008100}
8101
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008102Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008103 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8104 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8105 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8106
8107 // select true, X, Y -> X
8108 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008109 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008110 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008111
8112 // select C, X, X -> X
8113 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8114 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8115
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008116 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8118 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8119 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8120 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8121 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8122 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8123 else
8124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8125 }
8126
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008127 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008128 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008129 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008130 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008131 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008132 } else {
8133 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8134 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008135 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008136 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008137 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008138 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008139 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008140 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008141 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008142 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008143 } else {
8144 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8145 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008146 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008147 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008148 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008149 }
8150 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008151
8152 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8153 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8154 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008155 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008156 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008157 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008158 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008159
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008160 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8161 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8162 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008163 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008164 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008165 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008166 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008167 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008168 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008169 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008170 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008171 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008172 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008173
8174 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008175
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008176 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008177
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008178 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008179 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008180 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008181 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008182 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008183 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008184 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008185 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008186 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008187 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008188 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008189 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8190
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008191 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8192 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8193 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008194 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8195 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008196 if (SRASize < SISize)
8197 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8198 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8199 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008200 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008201 }
8202 }
8203
8204
8205 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008206 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008207 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8208 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008209 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008210 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008211 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8212 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8213 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008214 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8215 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8216 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008217 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8218 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008219 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8220 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008221 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008222 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008223 Value *V = ICA;
8224 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008225 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008226 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8228 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008229 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008230 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008231
8232 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008233 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8234 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008235 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008236 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8237 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8238 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8239 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8240 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8241 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8242 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8243 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8244 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008246 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008247 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008248 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8250 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8251
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008252 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008253 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008254 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8255 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8256 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8257 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8258 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8259 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8260 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8261 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8262 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8263 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8264 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008265 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008266 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8268 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8269 }
8270 }
8271
8272 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
8273 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8274 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
8275 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8276 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8277 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8278 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8279 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8281 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8282
8283 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
8284 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8285 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8286 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8287 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8288 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00008289 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008290 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8291 }
8292 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008293
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008294 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8295 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8296 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008297 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8298
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008299 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8300 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8301 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8302 return IV;
8303
8304 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8305 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008306 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8307 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8308 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8309 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8310 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8311 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8312 }
8313
8314 if (AddOp) {
8315 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8316 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8317 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8318 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8319 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8320 }
8321
8322 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008323 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8324 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8325 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8326 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8327 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8328 } else {
8329 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008330 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008331 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008332
8333 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8334 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8335 if (AddOp != TI)
8336 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8337 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008338 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8339 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008340
8341 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008342 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008343 }
8344 }
8345 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008346
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008347 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008348 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008349 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8350 // transformation we are doing here.
8351 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8352 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8353 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8354 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8355 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8356 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8357 OpToFold = 1;
8358 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8359 OpToFold = 2;
8360 }
8361
8362 if (OpToFold) {
8363 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008364 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008365 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8366 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008367 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008368 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008369 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008370 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008371 else {
8372 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8373 }
8374 }
8375 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008376
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008377 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8378 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8379 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8380 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8381 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8382 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8383 OpToFold = 1;
8384 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8385 OpToFold = 2;
8386 }
8387
8388 if (OpToFold) {
8389 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008390 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008391 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8392 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008393 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008394 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008395 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008396 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008397 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008398 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008399 }
8400 }
8401 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008402
8403 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8404 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8405 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8406 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8407 return &SI;
8408 }
8409
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008410 return 0;
8411}
8412
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008413/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8414/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8415/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8416/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8417/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8418///
8419static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8420 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008421
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008422 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8423 if (!U) return Align;
8424
8425 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8426 default: break;
8427 case Instruction::BitCast:
8428 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8429 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008430 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8431 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008432 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008433 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8434 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008435 AllZeroOperands = false;
8436 break;
8437 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008438
8439 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8440 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008441 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008442 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008443 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008444 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008445 }
8446
8447 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8448 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8449 // of the global.
8450 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8451 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8452 Align = PrefAlign;
8453 }
8454 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8455 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8456 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8457 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8458 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8459 Align = PrefAlign;
8460 }
8461 }
8462
8463 return Align;
8464}
8465
8466/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8467/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8468/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8469/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8470unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8471 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8472 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8473 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8474 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8475 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8476 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8477 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8478 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8479
8480 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8481 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8482
8483 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8484 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008485}
8486
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008487Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008488 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8489 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008490 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8491 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8492
8493 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8494 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8495 return MI;
8496 }
8497
8498 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8499 // load/store.
8500 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8501 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8502
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008503 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8504 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8505 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8506 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008507 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008508 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8509
8510 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008511 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008512
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008513 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008514 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008515
8516 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8517 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8518 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8519 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8520 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8521 // integer datatype.
8522 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8523 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8524 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8525 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8526 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008527 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008528 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8529 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8530 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8531 else
8532 break;
8533 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8534 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8535 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8536 else
8537 break;
8538 } else
8539 break;
8540 }
8541
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008542 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008543 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8544 }
8545 }
8546
8547
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008548 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8549 // infer, use it.
8550 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8551 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8552
8553 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8554 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008555 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8556 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8557 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8558
8559 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8560 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8561 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008562}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008563
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008564Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8565 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8566 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8567 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8568 return MI;
8569 }
8570
8571 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8572 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8573 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8574 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8575 return 0;
8576 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8577 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8578
8579 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8580 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8581
8582 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8583 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8584 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8585
8586 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8587 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8588
8589 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8590 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8591
8592 // Extract the fill value and store.
8593 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8594 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8595 Alignment), *MI);
8596
8597 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8598 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
8599 return MI;
8600 }
8601
8602 return 0;
8603}
8604
8605
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008606/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
8607/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
8608/// the heavy lifting.
8609///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008610Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008611 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
8612 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
8613
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008614 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
8615 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008616 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008617 bool Changed = false;
8618
8619 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
8620 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
8621 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8622
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008623 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008624 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008625 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
8626 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
8627 // alignment is sufficient.
8628 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008629 }
8630
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008631 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
8632 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
8633 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008634 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008635 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
8636 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
8637 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008638 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
8639 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
8640 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00008641 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008642 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
8643 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008644 Changed = true;
8645 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00008646
8647 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
8648 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
8649 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008650 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008651
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008652 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
8653 // set, update the alignment.
8654 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008655 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
8656 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008657 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
8658 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
8659 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008660 }
8661
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008662 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008663 }
8664
8665 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
8666 default: break;
8667 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8668 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
8669 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
8670 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
8671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
8672 break;
8673 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
8674 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
8675 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
8676 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
8677 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
8678 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8679 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8680 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8681 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
8682 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
8683 CI);
8684 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008685 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008686 break;
8687 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
8688 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
8689 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8690 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
8691 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8692 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
8693 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
8694 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
8695 }
8696 break;
8697 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
8698 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
8699 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008700 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8701 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8702 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8703 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
8704 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
8705 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
8706 }
8707 break;
8708
8709 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
8710 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
8711 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
8712 uint64_t UndefElts;
8713 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
8714 UndefElts)) {
8715 II->setOperand(1, V);
8716 return II;
8717 }
8718 break;
8719 }
8720
8721 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
8722 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
8723 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
8724 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008725
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008726 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
8727 bool AllEltsOk = true;
8728 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
8729 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
8730 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
8731 AllEltsOk = false;
8732 break;
8733 }
8734 }
8735
8736 if (AllEltsOk) {
8737 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
8738 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
8739 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
8740 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008741
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008742 // Only extract each element once.
8743 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
8744 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
8745
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008746 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008747 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
8748 continue;
8749 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
8750 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
8751
8752 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
8753 Instruction *Elt =
8754 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
8755 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
8756 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008757 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008758
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008759 // Insert this value into the result vector.
8760 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
8761 i, "tmp");
8762 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008763 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008764 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008765 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008766 }
8767 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008768
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008769 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
8770 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
8771 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
8772 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
8773 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
8774 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
8775 if (&*++BI == II)
8776 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008777 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008778 }
8779
8780 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
8781 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
8782 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
8783 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
8784 bool CannotRemove = false;
8785 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
8786 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
8787 CannotRemove = true;
8788 break;
8789 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00008790 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
8791 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
8792 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
8793 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
8794 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8795 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
8796 } else {
8797 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
8798 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00008799 CannotRemove = true;
8800 break;
8801 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008802 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008803 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008804
8805 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
8806 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
8807 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
8808 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8809 break;
8810 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008811 }
8812
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008813 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008814}
8815
8816// InvokeInst simplification
8817//
8818Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008819 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008820}
8821
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00008822/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
8823/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008824static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
8825 const CastInst * const CI,
8826 const TargetData * const TD,
8827 const int ix) {
8828 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
8829 return false;
8830
8831 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
8832 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
8833 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
8834 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, ParamAttr::ByVal))
8835 return true;
8836
8837 const Type* SrcTy =
8838 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
8839 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8840 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
8841 return false;
8842 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
8843 return false;
8844 return true;
8845}
8846
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008847// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
8848//
8849Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008850 bool Changed = false;
8851
8852 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
8853 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008854 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
8855
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008856 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008857
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008858 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
8859 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
8860 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
8861 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
8862 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008863 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008864 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
8865 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008866 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
8867 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
8868 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
8869 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
8870 return 0;
8871 }
8872
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008873 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
8874 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
8875 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
8876 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008877 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008878 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008879 CS.getInstruction());
8880
8881 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
8882 CS.getInstruction()->
8883 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
8884
8885 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
8886 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008887 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8888 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008889 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008890 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
8891 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008892
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008893 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
8894 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
8895 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
8896 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
8897
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008898 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8899 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8900 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00008901 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008902 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
8903 // the call.
8904 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008905 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
8906 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
8907 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
8908 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
8909 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008910 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008911 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008912 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008913
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008914 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008915 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008916 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008917 Changed = true;
8918 }
8919
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008920 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008921}
8922
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008923// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
8924// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
8925//
8926bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
8927 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
8928 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008929 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
8930 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008931 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008932 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008933 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008934 const PAListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getParamAttrs();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008935
8936 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
8937 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
8938 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
8939 //
8940 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
8941 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008942 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008943
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008944 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00008945 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
8946
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008947 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008948 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00008949 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008950 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
8951 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
8952 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00008953 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008954 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008955
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008956 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008957 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008958 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008959 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
8960
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008961 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8962 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008963 if (RAttrs & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00008964 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
8965 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008966
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008967 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8968 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8969 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8970 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8971 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8972 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8973 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8974 UI != E; ++UI)
8975 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8976 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008977 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008978 return false;
8979 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008980
8981 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8982 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008983
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008984 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8985 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8986 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008987 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008988
8989 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00008990 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
8991
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00008992 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1) & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
8993 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00008994
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008995 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
8996 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008997 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00008998 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
8999 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009000 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009001 }
9002
9003 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009004 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009005 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009006
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009007 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9008 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009009 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009010 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9011 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009012 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9013 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009014 break;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009015 ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009016 if (PAttrs & ParamAttr::VarArgsIncompatible)
9017 return false;
9018 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009019
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009020 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9021 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9022 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9023 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009024 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009025 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9026
9027 // Get any return attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009028 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009029
9030 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9031 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009032 RAttrs &= ~ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009033
9034 // Add the new return attributes.
9035 if (RAttrs)
9036 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009037
9038 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9039 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9040 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9041 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9042 Args.push_back(*AI);
9043 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009044 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009045 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009046 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009047 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009048 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009049
9050 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009051 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009052 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009053 }
9054
9055 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9056 // now...
9057 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9058 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9059
9060 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009061 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009062 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009063 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9064 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009065 } else {
9066 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9067 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9068 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9069 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9070 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009071 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9072 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009073 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009074 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9075 Args.push_back(Cast);
9076 } else {
9077 Args.push_back(*AI);
9078 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009079
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009080 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009081 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009082 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
9083 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009084 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009085 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009086
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009087 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009088 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009089
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009090 const PAListPtr &NewCallerPAL = PAListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009091
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009092 Instruction *NC;
9093 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009094 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009095 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9096 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009097 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009098 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009099 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009100 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9101 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009102 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9103 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009104 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009105 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009106 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009107 }
9108
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009109 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009110 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009111 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009112 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009113 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009114 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009115 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009116
9117 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9118 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9119 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009120 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009121 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9122 } else {
9123 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9124 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9125 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009126 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009127 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009128 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009129 }
9130 }
9131
9132 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9133 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009134 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009135 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009136 return true;
9137}
9138
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009139// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9140// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9141//
9142Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9143 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9144 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9145 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009146 const PAListPtr &Attrs = CS.getParamAttrs();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009147
9148 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9149 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009150 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(ParamAttr::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009151 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009152
9153 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9154 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9155
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009156 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009157 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9158 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9159
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009160 const PAListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getParamAttrs();
9161 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009162 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9163 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Dale Johannesen0d51e7e2008-02-19 21:38:47 +00009164 ParameterAttributes NestAttr = ParamAttr::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009165
9166 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9167 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9168 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009169 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009170 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9171 NestTy = *I;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009172 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009173 break;
9174 }
9175
9176 if (NestTy) {
9177 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9178 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9179 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9180
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009181 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
9182 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009183
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009184 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009185 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9186
9187 // Add any function result attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009188 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(0))
9189 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009190
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009191 {
9192 unsigned Idx = 1;
9193 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9194 do {
9195 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009196 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009197 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9198 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9199 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9200 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009201 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009202 }
9203
9204 if (I == E)
9205 break;
9206
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009207 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009208 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009209 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009210 NewAttrs.push_back
9211 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009212
9213 ++Idx, ++I;
9214 } while (1);
9215 }
9216
9217 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9218 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009219 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009220
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009221 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009222 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9223
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009224 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009225 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009226 {
9227 unsigned Idx = 1;
9228 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9229 E = FTy->param_end();
9230
9231 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009232 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9233 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009234 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009235
9236 if (I == E)
9237 break;
9238
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009239 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009240 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009241
9242 ++Idx, ++I;
9243 } while (1);
9244 }
9245
9246 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9247 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9248 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009249 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009250 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9251 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009252 const PAListPtr &NewPAL = PAListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009253
9254 Instruction *NewCaller;
9255 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009256 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9257 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9258 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9259 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009260 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009261 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009262 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009263 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9264 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009265 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9266 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9267 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9268 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009269 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009270 }
9271 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9272 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9273 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9274 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9275 return 0;
9276 }
9277 }
9278
9279 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9280 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9281 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9282 Constant *NewCallee =
9283 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9284 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9285 return CS.getInstruction();
9286}
9287
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009288/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9289/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9290/// and a single binop.
9291Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9292 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009293 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9294 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009295 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009296 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9297 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9298
9299 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9300 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009301
9302 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9303 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009304 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009305 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009306 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009307 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009308 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9309 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9310 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009311 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009312
9313 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9314 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9315 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9316 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9317 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009318
9319 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9320 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9321 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009322 }
9323
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009324 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9325
9326 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9327 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9328 // hide them behind a phi.
9329 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9330 return 0;
9331
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009332 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009333 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009334 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009335 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009336 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9337 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009338 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9339 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009340 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9341 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9342 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009343
9344 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009345 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9346 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009347 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9348 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009349 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9350 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9351 }
9352
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009353 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9354 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9355 if (NewLHS) {
9356 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9357 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9358 }
9359 if (NewRHS) {
9360 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9361 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9362 }
9363 }
9364
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009365 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009366 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009367 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009368 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009369 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009370 else {
9371 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009372 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009373 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009374}
9375
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009376/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9377/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9378/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9379/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009380///
9381/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9382/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9383/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009384static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9385 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9386
9387 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9388 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9389 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009390
9391 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9392 // profitable to do this xform.
9393 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9394 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9395 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9396 UI != E; ++UI) {
9397 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9398 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9399 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9400 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9401 }
9402 isAddressTaken = true;
9403 break;
9404 }
9405
9406 if (!isAddressTaken)
9407 return false;
9408 }
9409
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009410 return true;
9411}
9412
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009413
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009414// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9415// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9416// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9417Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9418 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9419
9420 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9421 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9422 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9423 // code size and simplifying code.
9424 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9425 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009426 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009427 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9428 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009429 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009430 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9431 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009432 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009433 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9434 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009435 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9436 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9437 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9438 // load and the PHI.
9439 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9440 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9441 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009442
9443 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9444 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9445 // the path through the other successor.
9446 if (isVolatile &&
9447 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9448 return 0;
9449
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009450 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009451 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009452 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9453 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9454 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009455 } else {
9456 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9457 }
9458
9459 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9460 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9461 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9462 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009463 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009464 return 0;
9465 if (CastSrcTy) {
9466 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9467 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009468 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009469 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9470 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009471 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9472 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9473 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9474 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009475
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009476 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9477 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9478 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009479 if (isVolatile &&
9480 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9481 return 0;
9482
9483
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009484 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9485 return 0;
9486 }
9487 }
9488
9489 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9490 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009491 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9492 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009493 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009494
9495 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9496 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009497
9498 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009499 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9500 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9501 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9502 InVal = 0;
9503 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9504 }
9505
9506 Value *PhiVal;
9507 if (InVal) {
9508 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9509 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9510 PhiVal = InVal;
9511 delete NewPN;
9512 } else {
9513 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9514 PhiVal = NewPN;
9515 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009516
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009517 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009518 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009519 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009520 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009521 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009522 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009523 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009524 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009525 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9526
9527 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9528 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9529 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9530 if (isVolatile)
9531 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9532 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9533
9534 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009535}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009536
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009537/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9538/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009539static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9540 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009541 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9542 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9543
9544 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009545 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009546 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009547
9548 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9549 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9550 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009551
9552 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9553 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009554
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009555 return false;
9556}
9557
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009558/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9559/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9560/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9561static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9562 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9563 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9564 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9565 return true;
9566
9567 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9568 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9569 return false;
9570
9571 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9572 // the value.
9573 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9574 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9575 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9576 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9577 return false;
9578 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9579 return false;
9580 }
9581
9582 return true;
9583}
9584
9585
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009586// PHINode simplification
9587//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009588Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00009589 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009590 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00009591
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009592 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
9593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
9594
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009595 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
9596 // reducing code size.
9597 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
9598 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
9599 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
9600 return Result;
9601
9602 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
9603 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
9604 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009605 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
9606 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
9607 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009608 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009609 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
9610 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
9611 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9612 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009613
9614 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
9615 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
9616 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
9617 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
9618 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
9619 // late.
9620 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
9621 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
9622 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
9623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9624 }
9625 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009626
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009627 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
9628 // same value, for example:
9629 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9630 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
9631 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
9632 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
9633 {
9634 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
9635 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
9636 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
9637 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
9638 ++InValNo;
9639
9640 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
9641 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
9642
9643 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
9644 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
9645 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
9646 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
9647 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
9648 break;
9649 }
9650
9651 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
9652 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
9653 // the value.
9654 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
9655 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
9656 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9657 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
9658 }
9659 }
9660 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00009661 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009662}
9663
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009664static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
9665 Instruction *InsertPoint,
9666 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00009667 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9668 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009669 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
9670 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
9671 // used for address computation.
9672 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
9673 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
9674 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
9675 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009676}
9677
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009678
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009679Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009680 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009681 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009682 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009683 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009684 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009685
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009686 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
9687 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
9688
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009689 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
9690 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
9691 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
9692
9693 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009695
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009696 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
9697 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009698
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009699 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009700 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
9701 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009702 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009703 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00009704 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
9705 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
9706 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
9707 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
9708 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
9709 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9710 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009711 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009712 }
9713 }
9714 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009715 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
9716 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
9717 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
9718 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009719 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009720 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009721 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009722 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009723 MadeChange = true;
9724 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009725 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9726 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009727 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009728 MadeChange = true;
9729 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009730 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009731 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009732 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009733 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
9734
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009735 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
9736 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
9737 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009738 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9739 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
9740 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
9741 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
9742 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
9743 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009744 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
9745 if (I != BCI) {
9746 I->takeName(BCI);
9747 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
9748 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
9749 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009750 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009751 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009752 }
9753 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
9754 }
9755 }
9756
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009757 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
9758 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
9759 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
9760 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009761 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00009762 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009763 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009764
9765 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009766 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
9767 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
9768 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
9769 //
9770 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
9771 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
9772 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
9773
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009774 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009775
9776 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
9777 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
9778 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
9779 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00009780 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009781
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009782 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009783 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00009784 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
9785 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
9786 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009787 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009788 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
9789 Sum = GO1;
9790 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
9791 Sum = SO1;
9792 } else {
9793 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
9794 // target's pointer size.
9795 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
9796 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009797 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009798 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009799 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009800 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009801 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
9802 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009803 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009804 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009805
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009806 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009807 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009808 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009809 } else {
9810 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009811 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
9812 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009813 }
9814 }
9815 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009816 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
9817 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
9818 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009819 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00009820 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009821 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009822 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009823
9824 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
9825 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
9826 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
9827 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
9828 return &GEP;
9829 } else {
9830 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9831 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
9832 Indices.push_back(Sum);
9833 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
9834 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009835 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009836 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009837 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009838 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009839 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9840 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009841 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
9842 }
9843
9844 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009845 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
9846 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009847
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009848 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009849 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
9850 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
9851
9852 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009853 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009854 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
9855 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
9856 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
9857
9858 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009859 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
9860 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009861
9862 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
9863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
9864 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009865 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009866 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
9867 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
9868 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009869 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
9870 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009871 //
9872 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
9873 //
9874 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
9875 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
9876 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
9877 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
9878 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
9879 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
9880 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
9881 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
9882 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
9883 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
9884 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
9885 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
9886 return &GEP;
9887 }
9888 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
9889 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009890 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
9891 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009892 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
9893 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
9894 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009895 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
9896 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009897 Value *Idx[2];
9898 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9899 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009900 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009901 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009902 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
9903 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009904 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009905
9906 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009907 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009908 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009909 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009910
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009911 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009912 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009913 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009914
9915 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
9916 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
9917 Value *NewIdx = 0;
9918 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
9919 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
9920 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
9921 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
9922 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00009923 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009924 Scale = CI;
9925 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
9926 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
9927 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00009928 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9929 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
9930 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009931 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9932 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
9933 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
9934 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9935 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9936 }
9937 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009938
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009939 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009940 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
9941 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
9942 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
9943 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
9944 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
9945 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
9946 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009947 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009948 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009949 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009950 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009951 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
9952 }
9953
9954 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009955 Value *Idx[2];
9956 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9957 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009958 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009959 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009960 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
9961 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
9962 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009963 }
9964 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009965 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009966 }
9967
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009968 return 0;
9969}
9970
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009971Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
9972 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009973 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009974 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
9975 const Type *NewTy =
9976 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009977 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009978
9979 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
9980 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009981 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009982 else {
9983 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00009984 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00009985 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00009986
9987 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009988
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009989 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
9990 // allocas if possible...
9991 //
9992 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
9993 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
9994
9995 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
9996 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
9997 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009998 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009999 Value *Idx[2];
10000 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10001 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010002 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10003 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010004
10005 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10006 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010007 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010008 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010010 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010011 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010012
10013 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10014 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10015 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010016 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010017 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10019
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010020 return 0;
10021}
10022
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010023Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10024 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10025
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010026 // free undef -> unreachable.
10027 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10028 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010029 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010030 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010031 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10032 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010033
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010034 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10035 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010036 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010037 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010038
10039 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10040 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10041 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10042 return &FI;
10043 }
10044
10045 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10046 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10047 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10048 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10049 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10050 return &FI;
10051 }
10052 }
10053
10054 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10055 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10056 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10057 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10058 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10059 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010060
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010061 return 0;
10062}
10063
10064
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010065/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010066static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010067 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010068 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010069 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010070
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010071 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10072 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10073 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010074 std::string Str;
10075 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010076 unsigned len = Str.length();
10077 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10078 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10079 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10080 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010081 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10082 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10083 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10084 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10085 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10086 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10087 }
10088 } else {
10089 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10090 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10091 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10092 }
10093 // Append NULL at the end.
10094 SingleChar = 0;
10095 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10096 }
10097 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10098 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010099 }
10100 }
10101 }
10102
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010103 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010104 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010105 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010106
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010107 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010108 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010109 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10110 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10111 // constants.
10112 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10113 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10114 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010115 Value *Idxs[2];
10116 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10117 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010118 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10119 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10120 }
10121
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010122 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010123 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010124 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10125 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10126 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010127 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10128 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010129
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010130 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10131 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10132 // the result of the loaded value.
10133 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10134 CI->getName(),
10135 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10136 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010137 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010138 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010139 }
10140 }
10141 return 0;
10142}
10143
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010144/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010145/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10146/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10147/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10148static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010149 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10150 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10151
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010152 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010153 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010154 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010155 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010156
10157 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10158 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010159 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10160 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10161 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010162 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10163
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010164 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010165 --BBI;
10166
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010167 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10168 // marked invalid.
10169 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10170 return false;
10171
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010172 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10173 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010174 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010175 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010176 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010177
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010178 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010179 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010180}
10181
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010182/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
10183/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
10184/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
10185/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
10186static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
10187 while (1) {
10188 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
10189 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
10190 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
10191 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
10192 else
10193 return Ptr;
10194 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
10195 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
10196 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
10197 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
10198 } else {
10199 return Ptr;
10200 }
10201 }
10202}
10203
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010204Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10205 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010206
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010207 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010208 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10209 if (KnownAlign >
10210 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10211 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010212 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10213
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010214 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010215 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010216 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010217 return Res;
10218
10219 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10220 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010221
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010222 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10223 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010224 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10225 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010226 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10227 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010229 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10230 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010232 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010233
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010234 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10235 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10236 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10237 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10238 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010239 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10240 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10241 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10242 // CFG.
10243 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10244 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10246 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010247 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010248
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010249 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010250 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010251 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10252 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10253 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010254 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10255 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10256 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010257 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10258 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010260 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010261
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010262 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10263 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010264 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010266
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010267 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010268 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010269 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10270 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010271 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010272 if (Constant *V =
10273 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010275 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10276 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10277 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10278 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10279 // CFG.
10280 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10281 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10282 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10283 }
10284
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010285 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010286 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010287 return Res;
10288 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010289 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010290 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010291
10292 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10293 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
10294 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
10295 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10296 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10298 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10299 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10300 }
10301 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010302
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010303 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010304 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10305 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10306 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10307 //
10308 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10309 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10310 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10311 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10312 // unconditionally.
10313 //
10314 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10315 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010316 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10317 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010318 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010319 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010320 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010321 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010322 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010323 }
10324
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010325 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10326 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10327 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10328 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10329 return &LI;
10330 }
10331
10332 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10333 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10334 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10335 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10336 return &LI;
10337 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010338 }
10339 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010340 return 0;
10341}
10342
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010343/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010344/// when possible.
10345static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10346 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10347 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10348
10349 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10350 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10351 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10352
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010353 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010354 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10355 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10356 // constants.
10357 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10358 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10359 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010360 Value* Idxs[2];
10361 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10362 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010363 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10364 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10365 }
10366
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010367 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10368 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10369 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010370
10371 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010372 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10373 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010374 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010375 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010376 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10377 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10378 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10379 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10380 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010381 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010382 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010383 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010384 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10385 }
10386 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010387 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010388 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010389 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010390 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010391 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010392 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10393 }
10394 }
10395 }
10396 return 0;
10397}
10398
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010399Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10400 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10401 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10402
10403 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010404 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010405 ++NumCombined;
10406 return 0;
10407 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010408
10409 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10410 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010411 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010412 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10413 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10414 ++NumCombined;
10415 return 0;
10416 }
10417
10418 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10419 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10420 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10421 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10422 ++NumCombined;
10423 return 0;
10424 }
10425 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010426
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010427 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010428 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10429 if (KnownAlign >
10430 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10431 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010432 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10433
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010434 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10435 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10436 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10437 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10438 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10439 --ScanInsts) {
10440 --BBI;
10441
10442 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10443 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10444 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10445 ++NumDeadStore;
10446 ++BBI;
10447 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10448 continue;
10449 }
10450 break;
10451 }
10452
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010453 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10454 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10455 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10456 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010457 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010458 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10459 ++NumCombined;
10460 return 0;
10461 }
10462 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10463 // may not be dead.
10464 break;
10465 }
10466
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010467 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010468 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010469 break;
10470 }
10471
10472
10473 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010474
10475 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10476 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10477 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10478 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10479 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010480 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010481 ++NumCombined;
10482 }
10483 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10484 }
10485
10486 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10487 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010488 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010489 ++NumCombined;
10490 return 0;
10491 }
10492
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010493 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10494 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010495 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010496 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10497 return Res;
10498 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010499 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010500 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10501 return Res;
10502
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010503
10504 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10505 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010506 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010507 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010508 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10509 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10510 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010511
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010512 return 0;
10513}
10514
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010515/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10516/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10517/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10518///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010519/// Simplify things like:
10520/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10521/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10522///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010523bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10524 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10525
10526 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10527 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10528 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010529 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010530
10531 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10532 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010533 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10534 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010535 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010536 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010537 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010538 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010539 return false;
10540
10541 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010542 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010543 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010544 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010545 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010546 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010547 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010548
10549 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10550 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10551 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10552 return false;
10553
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010554 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10555 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010556 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010557 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010558 return false;
10559
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010560 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10561 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10562 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10563 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10564 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10565 --BBI;
10566 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10567 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10568 return false;
10569 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010570 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010571 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10572 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10573 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10574 return false;
10575
10576 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010577 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10578 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010579 for (;; --BBI) {
10580 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10581 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10582 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10583 return false;
10584 break;
10585 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010586 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10587 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10588 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010589 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10590 return false;
10591 }
10592
10593 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010594 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10595 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010596 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10597 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010598 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010599 return false;
10600 }
10601 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010602
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010603 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010604 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
10605 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010606 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010607 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
10608 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010609 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
10610 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010611 }
10612
10613 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
10614 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010615 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010616 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
10617 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
10618
10619 // Nuke the old stores.
10620 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10621 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
10622 ++NumCombined;
10623 return true;
10624}
10625
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010626
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010627Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
10628 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000010629 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010630 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
10631 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
10632 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
10633 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
10634 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10635 BI.setCondition(X);
10636 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10637 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
10638 return &BI;
10639 }
10640
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010641 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
10642 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
10643 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10644 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10645 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
10646 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10647 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010648 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010649 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10650 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010651 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10652 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
10653 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10654 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010655 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010656 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010657 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010658 return &BI;
10659 }
10660
10661 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
10662 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
10663 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10664 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10665 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
10666 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
10667 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10668 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010669 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010670 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10671 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010672 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010673 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010674 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10675 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010676 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010677 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010678 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010679 return &BI;
10680 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010681
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010682 return 0;
10683}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010684
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010685Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
10686 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
10687 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
10688 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
10689 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
10690 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
10691 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010692 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010693 AddRHS));
10694 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010695 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010696 return &SI;
10697 }
10698 }
10699 return 0;
10700}
10701
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010702Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010703 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010704
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010705 if (!EV.hasIndices())
10706 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
10707
10708 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
10709 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
10710 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
10711
10712 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
10713 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
10714
10715 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
10716 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
10717 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
10718 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
10719 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
10720 // first index
10721 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
10722 else
10723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
10724 }
10725 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
10726 }
10727 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
10728 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
10729 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
10730 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
10731 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
10732 exti != exte && insi != inse;
10733 ++exti, ++insi) {
10734 if (*insi != *exti)
10735 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
10736 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
10737 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
10738 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
10739 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10740 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
10741 // with
10742 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
10743 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10744 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
10745 }
10746 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
10747 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
10748 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10749 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
10750 // with "i32 42"
10751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
10752 if (exti == exte) {
10753 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
10754 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10755 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
10756 // with
10757 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
10758 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
10759 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
10760 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
10761 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
10762 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10763 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
10764 EV);
10765 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
10766 insi, inse);
10767 }
10768 if (insi == inse)
10769 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
10770 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
10771 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
10772 // i.e., replace
10773 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10774 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
10775 // with
10776 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
10777 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
10778 exti, exte);
10779 }
10780 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
10781 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
10782 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
10783 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010784 return 0;
10785}
10786
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010787/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
10788/// is to leave as a vector operation.
10789static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
10790 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10791 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010792 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010793 if (isConstant) return true;
10794 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
10795 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
10796 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
10797 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
10798 return false;
10799 return true;
10800 }
10801 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
10802 if (!I) return false;
10803
10804 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
10805 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
10806 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
10807 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
10808 return true;
10809 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
10810 return true;
10811 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
10812 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
10813 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10814 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10815 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010816 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
10817 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
10818 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10819 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10820 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010821
10822 return false;
10823}
10824
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000010825/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
10826///
10827/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
10828/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010829static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
10830 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10831 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10832 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
10833 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10834 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
10835
10836 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010837 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010838 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
10839 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010840 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
10841 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010842 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010843 return Result;
10844}
10845
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010846/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
10847/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
10848/// extracted from the vector.
10849static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010850 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
10851 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010852 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
10853 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010854 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10855
10856 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
10857 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10858 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10859 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010860 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010861 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
10862 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10863 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010864 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
10865 return 0;
10866 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010867
10868 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
10869 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010870 if (EltNo == IIElt)
10871 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010872
10873 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
10874 // vector input.
10875 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010876 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010877 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
10878 if (InEl < Width)
10879 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
10880 else if (InEl < Width*2)
10881 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
10882 else
10883 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010884 }
10885
10886 // Otherwise, we don't know.
10887 return 0;
10888}
10889
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010890Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010891 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010892 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10894
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010895 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010896 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
10898
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010899 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000010900 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
10901 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
10902 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010903 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010904 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010905 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
10906 op0 = 0;
10907 break;
10908 }
10909 if (op0)
10910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010911 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010912
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010913 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
10914 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010915 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010916 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
10917 unsigned VectorWidth =
10918 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
10919
10920 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
10921 // crashing the code below.
10922 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
10923 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10924
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010925 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
10926 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
10927 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010928 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010929 uint64_t UndefElts;
10930 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010931 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010932 UndefElts)) {
10933 EI.setOperand(0, V);
10934 return &EI;
10935 }
10936 }
10937
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010938 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000010940
10941 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
10942 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
10943 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
10944 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
10945 if (const VectorType *VT =
10946 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
10947 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
10948 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
10949 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
10950 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010951 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010952
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010953 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010954 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10955 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
10956 // profitable to do so
10957 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010958 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
10959 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
10960 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
10961 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
10962 EI.getName()+".lhs");
10963 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
10964 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
10965 EI.getName()+".rhs");
10966 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
10967 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010968 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010969 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010970 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010971 unsigned AS =
10972 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000010973 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
10974 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010975 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
10976 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010977 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
10978 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000010979 }
10980 }
10981 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
10982 // Extracting the inserted element?
10983 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
10984 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
10985 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
10986 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
10987 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
10988 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10989 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
10990 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
10991 return &EI;
10992 }
10993 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
10994 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
10995 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010996 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
10997 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010998 Value *Src;
10999 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
11000 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
11001 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
11002 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11003 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11004 } else {
11005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011006 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011007 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011008 }
11009 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011010 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011011 return 0;
11012}
11013
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011014/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11015/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11016/// Otherwise, return false.
11017static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11018 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11019 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11020 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011021 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011022
11023 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011024 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011025 return true;
11026 } else if (V == LHS) {
11027 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011028 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011029 return true;
11030 } else if (V == RHS) {
11031 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011032 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011033 return true;
11034 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11035 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11036 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11037 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11038 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11039
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011040 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11041 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011042 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011043
11044 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11045 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11046 // transitively ok.
11047 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11048 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011049 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011050 return true;
11051 }
11052 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11053 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011054 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11055 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011056 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011057
11058 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11059 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11060 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11061 // transitively ok.
11062 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11063 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11064 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011065 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011066 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011067 } else {
11068 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011069 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011070 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011071
11072 }
11073 return true;
11074 }
11075 }
11076 }
11077 }
11078 }
11079 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11080
11081 return false;
11082}
11083
11084/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11085/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11086/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011087static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011088 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011089 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011090 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011091 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011092 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011093
11094 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011095 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011096 return V;
11097 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011098 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011099 return V;
11100 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11101 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11102 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11103 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11104 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11105
11106 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11107 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11108 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11109 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011110 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11111 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011112
11113 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11114 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011115 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11116 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11117 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011118 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011119 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011120 return V;
11121 }
11122
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011123 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11124 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011125 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11126 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11127 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011128 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011129 }
11130 return V;
11131 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011132
11133 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11134 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11135 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11136 return EI->getOperand(0);
11137
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011138 }
11139 }
11140 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011141 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011142
11143 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11144 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011145 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011146 return V;
11147}
11148
11149Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11150 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11151 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11152 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11153
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011154 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11155 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11156 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11157
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011158 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11159 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11160 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11161 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11162 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11163 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011164 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11165 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011166 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011167
11168 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11169 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11170
11171 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11173
11174 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11175 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11176 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11178
11179 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11180 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11181 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11182 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11183 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11184 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11185 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11186 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11187 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11188 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011189 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011190 else {
11191 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011192 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011193 NumVectorElts));
11194 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011195 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011196 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011197 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011198 }
11199
11200 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11201 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11202 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11203 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011204 Value *RHS = 0;
11205 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11206 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11207 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011208 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011209 }
11210 }
11211 }
11212
11213 return 0;
11214}
11215
11216
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011217Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11218 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11219 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011220 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011221
11222 bool MadeChange = false;
11223
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011224 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011225 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011226 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
11227
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011228 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011229 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011230 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
11231 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
11232 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
11233 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11234 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
11235 Mask[i] = 2*e;
11236 MadeChange = true;
11237 }
11238 }
11239
11240 if (MadeChange) {
11241 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11242 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11243 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11244 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
11245 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11246 else
11247 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11248 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011249 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +000011250 }
11251 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011252
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011253 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11254 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11255 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11256 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011257 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11258 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11259 }
11260
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011261 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11262 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11263 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011264 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011265 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011266 else {
11267 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011268 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011269 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011270 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11271 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011272 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011273 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11274 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011275 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011276 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011277 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011278 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011279 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011280 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11281 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011282 MadeChange = true;
11283 }
11284
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011285 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011286 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011287
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011288 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11289 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11290 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11291 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11292
11293 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11294 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011295 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011296
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011297 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11298 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11299 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011300
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011301 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11302 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11303 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11304 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11305 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11306 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11307 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11308 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11309 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11310 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11311 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11312 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11313
11314 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11315 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11316 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11317 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11318 else
11319 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11320
11321 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11322 // the replacement.
11323 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11324 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11325 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11326 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011327 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011328 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011329 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011330 }
11331 }
11332 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11333 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011334 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011335 }
11336 }
11337 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011338
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011339 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11340}
11341
11342
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011343
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011344
11345/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11346/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11347/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11348/// end of its block.
11349static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11350 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11351
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011352 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011353 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11354 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011355
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011356 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011357 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11358 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011359 return false;
11360
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011361 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11362 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011363 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11364 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011365 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11366 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11367 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011368 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011369
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011370 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011371
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011372 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011373 ++NumSunkInst;
11374 return true;
11375}
11376
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011377
11378/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11379/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11380///
11381/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11382/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11383/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11384/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11385/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11386///
11387static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011388 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011389 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011390 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011391 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011392 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011393
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011394 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11395 BB = Worklist.back();
11396 Worklist.pop_back();
11397
11398 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11399 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11400
11401 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11402 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011403
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011404 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11405 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11406 ++NumDeadInst;
11407 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11408 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11409 continue;
11410 }
11411
11412 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11413 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11414 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11415 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11416 ++NumConstProp;
11417 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11418 continue;
11419 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011420
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011421 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011422 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011423
11424 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11425 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11426 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11427 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11428 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11429 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011430 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011431 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011432 continue;
11433 }
11434 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11435 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11436 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11437 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11438 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011439 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011440 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011441 continue;
11442 }
11443
11444 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11445 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11446 continue;
11447 }
11448 }
11449
11450 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11451 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011452 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011453}
11454
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011455bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011456 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011457 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011458
11459 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11460 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011461
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011462 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011463 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11464 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11465 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011466 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011467 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011468
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011469 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11470 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11471 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11472 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11473 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11474 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11475 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11476 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011477
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011478 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011479 ++NumDeadInst;
11480
11481 if (!I->use_empty())
11482 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11483 I->eraseFromParent();
11484 }
11485 }
11486 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011487
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011488 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11489 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11490 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011491
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011492 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011493 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011494 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011495 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011496 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011497 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011498
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011499 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011500
11501 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011502 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011503 continue;
11504 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011505
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011506 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011507 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011508 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011509
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011510 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011511 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011512 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11513
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011514 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011515 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011516 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011517 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011518 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011519
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011520 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11521 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11522 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11523 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11524 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11525 i->set(NewC);
11526 }
11527 }
11528 }
11529
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011530 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000011531 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011532 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11533 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11534 if (UserParent != BB) {
11535 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11536 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11537 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11538 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11539 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11540 break;
11541 }
11542
11543 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11544 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11545 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11546 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11547 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11548 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11549 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11550 }
11551 }
11552
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011553 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011554#ifndef NDEBUG
11555 std::string OrigI;
11556#endif
11557 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011558 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011559 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011560 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011561 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011562 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11563 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011564
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011565 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11566 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11567
11568 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011569 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011570 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011571
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011572 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11573 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011574
11575 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11576 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011577 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11578
11579 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11580 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11581 ++InsertPos;
11582
11583 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011584
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011585 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11586 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011587 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011588
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011589 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11590 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011591 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011592
11593 // Erase the old instruction.
11594 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011595 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011596#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011597 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11598 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011599#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011600
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011601 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11602 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011603 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11604 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11605 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011606 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011607
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011608 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011609 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011610 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011611 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011612 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011613 AddToWorkList(I);
11614 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011615 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011616 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011617 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011618 }
11619 }
11620
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011621 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000011622
11623 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
11624 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011625 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011626}
11627
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011628
11629bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011630 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
11631
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011632 bool EverMadeChange = false;
11633
11634 // Iterate while there is work to do.
11635 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000011636 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011637 EverMadeChange = true;
11638 return EverMadeChange;
11639}
11640
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000011641FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011642 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011643}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000011644
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000011645